Only pad the tesxt section if the data section is going to follow it.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518
KB
2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
e9c75b65 34@set DATE April 2001
c906108c 35
6d2ebf8b 36@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
c906108c 37
c906108c 38@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 39@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
40@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41@direntry
c906108c 42* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
43@end direntry
44
c906108c
SS
45@ifinfo
46This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
5d161b24 49This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
50of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
e9c75b65
EZ
53Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
54 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 55
e9c75b65
EZ
56Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
59Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
60Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
61with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 62
e9c75b65
EZ
63(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
64this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
65Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
66@end ifinfo
67
68@titlepage
69@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
70@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 71@sp 1
c906108c
SS
72@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
73@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 74@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 75@page
c906108c
SS
76@tex
77{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 78\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
79\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
80\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
81}
82@end tex
53a5351d 83
c906108c 84@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
e9c75b65
EZ
85Copyright @copyright{} 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
86 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 87@sp 2
c906108c
SS
88Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
8959 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
90Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 91ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
92
93Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
94under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
95any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
96Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
97Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
98with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
99
100(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
101this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
102Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
103@end titlepage
104@page
105
b9deaee7 106@ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
107@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
c906108c
SS
109@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
111This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
5d161b24 113This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
114@value{GDBVN}.
115
e9c75b65 116Copyright (C) 1988-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
117
118@menu
119* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
120* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
121
122* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
123* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
124* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
125* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
126* Stack:: Examining the stack
127* Source:: Examining source files
128* Data:: Examining data
b37052ae 129* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
6d2ebf8b
SS
130
131* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
132
133* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
134* Altering:: Altering execution
135* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
136* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
137* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
138* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
139* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
140* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
141* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 142* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
143
144* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
145* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
146
147* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
148* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
149* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
150* Index:: Index
151@end menu
152
b9deaee7 153@end ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
154
155@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
156
157@ifhtml
158@node Top
159
160@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
161
162This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
163
b37052ae 164This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
6d2ebf8b
SS
165@value{GDBVN}.
166
167Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
168
c906108c
SS
169@menu
170* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 171* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
172
173* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
174* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
175* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
176* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
177* Stack:: Examining the stack
178* Source:: Examining source files
179* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 180
7a292a7a 181* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
182
183* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
184* Altering:: Altering execution
185* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
186* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 187* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
188* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
189* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 190* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6d2ebf8b 191* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
c906108c
SS
192
193* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 194* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
195
196* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
197* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
198* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
199* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
200@end menu
201
6d2ebf8b
SS
202@end ifhtml
203
449f3b6c
AC
204@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
205@iftex
206@contents
207@end iftex
208
6d2ebf8b 209@node Summary
c906108c
SS
210@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
211
212The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
213going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
214program was doing at the moment it crashed.
215
216@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
217these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
218
219@itemize @bullet
220@item
221Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
222
223@item
224Make your program stop on specified conditions.
225
226@item
227Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
228
229@item
230Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
231effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
232@end itemize
233
cce74817 234You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 235For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
236For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
237
cce74817
JM
238@cindex Chill
239@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 240Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 241see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 242
cce74817
JM
243@cindex Pascal
244Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
245nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
246entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
247syntax.
c906108c 248
c906108c
SS
249@cindex Fortran
250@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 251it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 252underscore.
c906108c 253
c906108c
SS
254@menu
255* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
256* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257@end menu
258
6d2ebf8b 259@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
260@unnumberedsec Free software
261
5d161b24 262@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
263General Public License
264(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273from anyone else.
274
6d2ebf8b 275@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
276@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
277
278Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
279other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
280development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
281of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
282to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
283file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
284blow-by-blow account.
285
286Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
287
288@quotation
289@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
290or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
291omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
292@end quotation
293
294So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
295particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
296releases:
b37052ae 297Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
c906108c
SS
298Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
299Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
300Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
301Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
302Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
303John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
304Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
305and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
306
307Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
308Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
309
b37052ae
EZ
310Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
311in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
312Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
313demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
314much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 315
b37052ae 316@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
317object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
318Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
319
320David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
321the original support for encapsulated COFF.
322
96c405b3 323Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
324
325Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
326Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
327support.
328Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
329Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
330Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
331David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
332Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
333Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
334Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
335Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
336Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
337Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
338Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
339Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
340Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
341Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
342Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
343
344Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
345
346Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
347libraries.
348
349Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
350about several machine instruction sets.
351
352Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
353remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
354contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
355and RDI targets, respectively.
356
357Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
358command-line editing and command history.
359
7a292a7a
SS
360Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
361Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 362
5d161b24 363Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 364He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 365symbols.
c906108c
SS
366
367Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
368Super-H processors.
369
370NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
371
372Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
373
374Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
375
376Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
377
96a2c332 378Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
379
380Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
381watchpoints.
382
383Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
384
385Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
386
387Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 388nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
389
390The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
391support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 392(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
393compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
394John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
395Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
396information in this manual.
397
b37052ae
EZ
398DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
399Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
400
96a2c332
SS
401Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
402development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
403fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
404Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
405Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
406Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
407Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
408addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
409JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
410Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
411Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
412Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
413Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
414Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
415Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
416
417
6d2ebf8b 418@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
419@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
420
421You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
422However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
423debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
424
425@iftex
426In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
427to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
428@end iftex
429
430@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
431@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
432
433One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
434processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
435quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
436definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
437session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
438then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
439same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
440@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
441procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
442
443@smallexample
444$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
445$ @b{./m4}
446@b{define(foo,0000)}
447
448@b{foo}
4490000
450@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
451
452@b{bar}
4530000
454@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
455
456@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
457@b{baz}
458@b{C-d}
459m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
460@end smallexample
461
462@noindent
463Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
464
c906108c
SS
465@smallexample
466$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
467@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
468@c FIXME... format to come out better.
469@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 470 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 471 the conditions.
5d161b24 472There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
473 for details.
474
475@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
476(@value{GDBP})
477@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
478
479@noindent
480@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
481rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
482We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
483that examples fit in this manual.
484
485@smallexample
486(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
487@end smallexample
488
489@noindent
490We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
491Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
492@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
493@code{break} command.
494
495@smallexample
496(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
497Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
498@end smallexample
499
500@noindent
501Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
502control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
503subroutine, the program runs as usual:
504
505@smallexample
506(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
507Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
508@b{define(foo,0000)}
509
510@b{foo}
5110000
512@end smallexample
513
514@noindent
515To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
516suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
517context where it stops.
518
519@smallexample
520@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
521
5d161b24 522Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
523 at builtin.c:879
524879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
525@end smallexample
526
527@noindent
528Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
529the next line of the current function.
530
531@smallexample
532(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
534 : nil,
535@end smallexample
536
537@noindent
538@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
539by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
540@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
541subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
542
543@smallexample
544(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
545set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
546 at input.c:530
547530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
548@end smallexample
549
550@noindent
551The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
552suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
553shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
554command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
555in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
556stack frame for each active subroutine.
557
558@smallexample
559(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
560#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
561 at input.c:530
5d161b24 562#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
563 at builtin.c:882
564#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
565#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
566 at macro.c:71
567#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
568#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
569@end smallexample
570
571@noindent
572We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
573times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
574falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
575
576@smallexample
577(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5780x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
579(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5800x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
581def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
582(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
583536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
584 : xstrdup(rq);
585(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
586538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
587@end smallexample
588
589@noindent
590The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
591@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
592and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
593(@code{print}) to see their values.
594
595@smallexample
596(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
597$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
599$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
600@end smallexample
601
602@noindent
603@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
604To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
605surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
606
607@smallexample
608(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
609533 xfree(rquote);
610534
611535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
612 : xstrdup (lq);
613536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
614 : xstrdup (rq);
615537
616538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
617539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
618540 @}
619541
620542 void
621@end smallexample
622
623@noindent
624Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
625@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
626
627@smallexample
628(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
629539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
630(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631540 @}
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
633$3 = 9
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
635$4 = 7
636@end smallexample
637
638@noindent
639That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
640@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
641@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
642the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
643any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
644assignments.
645
646@smallexample
647(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
648$5 = 7
649(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
650$6 = 9
651@end smallexample
652
653@noindent
654Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
655@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
656executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
657example that caused trouble initially:
658
659@smallexample
660(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
661Continuing.
662
663@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
664
665baz
6660000
667@end smallexample
668
669@noindent
670Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
671problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
672lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
673
674@smallexample
675@b{C-d}
676Program exited normally.
677@end smallexample
678
679@noindent
680The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
681indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
682session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
683
684@smallexample
685(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
686@end smallexample
c906108c 687
6d2ebf8b 688@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
689@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
690
691This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 692The essentials are:
c906108c 693@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 694@item
53a5351d 695type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 696@item
c906108c
SS
697type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
698@end itemize
699
700@menu
701* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
702* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
703* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
704@end menu
705
6d2ebf8b 706@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
707@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
708
c906108c
SS
709Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
710@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
711
712You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
713to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
714
c906108c
SS
715The command-line options described here are designed
716to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 717options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
718
719The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
720specifying an executable program:
721
722@example
723@value{GDBP} @var{program}
724@end example
725
c906108c
SS
726@noindent
727You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
728specified:
729
730@example
731@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
732@end example
733
734You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
735to debug a running process:
736
737@example
738@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
739@end example
740
741@noindent
742would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
743named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
744
c906108c 745Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
746complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
747debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
748``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
749will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 750
96a2c332 751You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
752@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
753
754@smallexample
755@value{GDBP} -silent
756@end smallexample
757
758@noindent
759You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
760options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
761
762@noindent
763Type
764
765@example
766@value{GDBP} -help
767@end example
768
769@noindent
770to display all available options and briefly describe their use
771(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
772
773All options and command line arguments you give are processed
774in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
775@samp{-x} option is used.
776
777
778@menu
c906108c
SS
779* File Options:: Choosing files
780* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
781@end menu
782
6d2ebf8b 783@node File Options
c906108c
SS
784@subsection Choosing files
785
2df3850c 786When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
787specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
788the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
789@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
790that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
791@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
792that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
793the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
794
795If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
796such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
797argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
798
799Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
800following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
801them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
802(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
803than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
804
d700128c
EZ
805@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
806@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
807@c it.
808
c906108c
SS
809@table @code
810@item -symbols @var{file}
811@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
812@cindex @code{--symbols}
813@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
814Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
815
816@item -exec @var{file}
817@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
818@cindex @code{--exec}
819@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
820Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
821and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
822
823@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 824@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
825Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
826file.
827
c906108c
SS
828@item -core @var{file}
829@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
830@cindex @code{--core}
831@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
832Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
833
834@item -c @var{number}
835Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
836(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
837case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
838
839@item -command @var{file}
840@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
841@cindex @code{--command}
842@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
843Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
844Files,, Command files}.
845
846@item -directory @var{directory}
847@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
848@cindex @code{--directory}
849@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
850Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
851
c906108c
SS
852@item -m
853@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
854@cindex @code{--mapped}
855@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
856@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
857supported on all systems.}@*
858If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 859system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
860to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
861program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 862called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
863Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
864and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
865the symbol table from the executable program.
866
867The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
868is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
869table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 870
c906108c
SS
871@item -r
872@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
873@cindex @code{--readnow}
874@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
875Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
876the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
877This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 878
c906108c
SS
879@end table
880
2df3850c 881You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 882order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
883information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
884on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
885but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
886
887@example
2df3850c 888gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 889@end example
c906108c 890
6d2ebf8b 891@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
892@subsection Choosing modes
893
894You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
895batch mode or quiet mode.
896
897@table @code
898@item -nx
899@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
900@cindex @code{--nx}
901@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c
JM
902Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
903called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
904@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
905options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
906files}.
c906108c
SS
907
908@item -quiet
d700128c 909@itemx -silent
c906108c 910@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
911@cindex @code{--quiet}
912@cindex @code{--silent}
913@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
914``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
915messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
916
917@item -batch
d700128c 918@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
919Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
920command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
921initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
922nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
923in the command files.
924
2df3850c
JM
925Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
926example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
927make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
928
929@example
930Program exited normally.
931@end example
932
933@noindent
2df3850c
JM
934(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
935@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
936mode.
937
938@item -nowindows
939@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
940@cindex @code{--nowindows}
941@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 942``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 943(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
944interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
945
946@item -windows
947@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
948@cindex @code{--windows}
949@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
950If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
951used if possible.
c906108c
SS
952
953@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 954@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
955Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
956instead of the current directory.
957
c906108c
SS
958@item -fullname
959@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
960@cindex @code{--fullname}
961@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
962@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
963subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
964number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
965displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
966recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
967the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
968and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
969@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
970frame.
c906108c 971
d700128c
EZ
972@item -epoch
973@cindex @code{--epoch}
974The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
975@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
976routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
977separate window.
978
979@item -annotate @var{level}
980@cindex @code{--annotate}
981This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
982effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
983(@pxref{Annotations}).
984Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
985together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
986types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
987@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
988maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
989
990@item -async
991@cindex @code{--async}
992Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
993@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
994special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
995commands in parallel with the debugged process being
996run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
997MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
998suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
999control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1000(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1001operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1002yet.)
1003@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1004@c should be removed.
1005
1006When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1007uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1008@samp{-noasync} option.
1009
1010@item -noasync
1011@cindex @code{--noasync}
1012Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1013
2df3850c
JM
1014@item -baud @var{bps}
1015@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1016@cindex @code{--baud}
1017@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1018Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1019interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1020
1021@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1022@itemx -t @var{device}
1023@cindex @code{--tty}
1024@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1025Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1026@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1027
53a5351d
JM
1028@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1029@c @item -tui
d700128c 1030@c @cindex @code{--tui}
53a5351d
JM
1031@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
1032@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1033@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
1034@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1035@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1036
1037@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1038@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1039@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1040@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1041@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1042@c systems.
1043
d700128c
EZ
1044@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1045@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1046Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1047program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1048communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. For example,
1049@samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
7162c0ca 1050interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}).
d700128c
EZ
1051
1052@item -write
1053@cindex @code{--write}
1054Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1055is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1056(@pxref{Patching}).
1057
1058@item -statistics
1059@cindex @code{--statistics}
1060This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1061memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1062
1063@item -version
1064@cindex @code{--version}
1065This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1066no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1067
c906108c
SS
1068@end table
1069
6d2ebf8b 1070@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1071@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1072@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1073@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1074
1075@table @code
1076@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1077@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1078@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1079@itemx q
1080To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1081@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1082do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1083otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1084error code.
c906108c
SS
1085@end table
1086
1087@cindex interrupt
1088An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1089terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1090returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1091character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1092until a time when it is safe.
1093
c906108c
SS
1094If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1095device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1096(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1097
6d2ebf8b 1098@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1099@section Shell commands
1100
1101If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1102debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1103just use the @code{shell} command.
1104
1105@table @code
1106@kindex shell
1107@cindex shell escape
1108@item shell @var{command string}
1109Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1110If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1111shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1112(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1113@end table
1114
1115The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1116You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1117@value{GDBN}:
1118
1119@table @code
1120@kindex make
1121@cindex calling make
1122@item make @var{make-args}
1123Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1124arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1125@end table
1126
6d2ebf8b 1127@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1128@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1129
1130You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1131name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1132@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1133key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1134show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1135
1136@menu
1137* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1138* Completion:: Command completion
1139* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1140@end menu
1141
6d2ebf8b 1142@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1143@section Command syntax
1144
1145A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1146how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1147arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1148command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1149step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1150with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1151
1152@cindex abbreviation
1153@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1154unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1155documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1156abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1157equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1158names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1159arguments to the @code{help} command.
1160
1161@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1162@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1163A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1164repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1165will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1166repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1167repeat.
1168
1169The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1170@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1171exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1172
1173@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1174output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1175(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1176@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1177repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1178
41afff9a 1179@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1180@cindex comment
1181Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1182nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1183Files,,Command files}).
1184
6d2ebf8b 1185@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1186@section Command completion
1187
1188@cindex completion
1189@cindex word completion
1190@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1191only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1192are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1193commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1194
1195Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1196of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1197word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1198enter it). For example, if you type
1199
1200@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1201@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1202@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1203@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1204@example
1205(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1206@end example
1207
1208@noindent
1209@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1210the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1211
1212@example
1213(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1214@end example
1215
1216@noindent
1217You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1218breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1219@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1220were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1221might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1222to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1223
1224If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1225@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1226characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1227@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1228example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1229begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1230just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1231function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1232example:
1233
1234@example
1235(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1236@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1237make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1238make_abs_section make_function_type
1239make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1240make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1241make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1242(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1243@end example
1244
1245@noindent
1246After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1247partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1248command.
1249
1250If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1251can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1252means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1253key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1254one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1255
1256@cindex quotes in commands
1257@cindex completion of quoted strings
1258Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1259parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1260its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1261situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1262@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1263
c906108c 1264The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1265name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1266overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1267by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1268may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1269that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1270that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1271word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1272@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1273@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1274when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c
SS
1275
1276@example
96a2c332 1277(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1278bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1279(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1280@end example
1281
1282In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1283quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1284completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1285place:
1286
1287@example
1288(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1289@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1290(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1291@end example
1292
1293@noindent
1294In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1295you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1296completion on an overloaded symbol.
1297
d4f3574e 1298For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1299expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1300overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1301see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1302
1303
6d2ebf8b 1304@node Help
c906108c
SS
1305@section Getting help
1306@cindex online documentation
1307@kindex help
1308
5d161b24 1309You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1310using the command @code{help}.
1311
1312@table @code
41afff9a 1313@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1314@item help
1315@itemx h
1316You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1317display a short list of named classes of commands:
1318
1319@smallexample
1320(@value{GDBP}) help
1321List of classes of commands:
1322
2df3850c 1323aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1324breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1325data -- Examining data
c906108c 1326files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1327internals -- Maintenance commands
1328obscure -- Obscure features
1329running -- Running the program
1330stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1331status -- Status inquiries
1332support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1333tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1334 stopping the program
c906108c 1335user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1336
5d161b24 1337Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1338commands in that class.
5d161b24 1339Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1340documentation.
1341Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1342(@value{GDBP})
1343@end smallexample
96a2c332 1344@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1345
1346@item help @var{class}
1347Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1348list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1349help display for the class @code{status}:
1350
1351@smallexample
1352(@value{GDBP}) help status
1353Status inquiries.
1354
1355List of commands:
1356
1357@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1358@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1359info -- Generic command for showing things
1360 about the program being debugged
1361show -- Generic command for showing things
1362 about the debugger
c906108c 1363
5d161b24 1364Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1365documentation.
1366Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1367(@value{GDBP})
1368@end smallexample
1369
1370@item help @var{command}
1371With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1372short paragraph on how to use that command.
1373
6837a0a2
DB
1374@kindex apropos
1375@item apropos @var{args}
1376The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1377commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1378@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1379
1380@smallexample
1381apropos reload
1382@end smallexample
1383
b37052ae
EZ
1384@noindent
1385results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1386
1387@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1388@c @group
1389set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1390 multiple times in one run
1391show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1392 multiple times in one run
1393@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1394@end smallexample
1395
c906108c
SS
1396@kindex complete
1397@item complete @var{args}
1398The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1399for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1400command you want completed. For example:
1401
1402@smallexample
1403complete i
1404@end smallexample
1405
1406@noindent results in:
1407
1408@smallexample
1409@group
2df3850c
JM
1410if
1411ignore
c906108c
SS
1412info
1413inspect
c906108c
SS
1414@end group
1415@end smallexample
1416
1417@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1418@end table
1419
1420In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1421and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1422of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1423manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1424under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1425all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1426
1427@c @group
1428@table @code
1429@kindex info
41afff9a 1430@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1431@item info
1432This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1433program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1434with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1435registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1436You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1437@w{@code{help info}}.
1438
1439@kindex set
1440@item set
5d161b24 1441You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1442@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1443@code{set prompt $}.
1444
1445@kindex show
1446@item show
5d161b24 1447In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1448@value{GDBN} itself.
1449You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1450related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1451system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1452which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1453
1454@kindex info set
1455To display all the settable parameters and their current
1456values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1457@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1458@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1459@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1460@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1461@end table
1462@c @end group
1463
1464Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1465exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1466
1467@table @code
1468@kindex show version
1469@cindex version number
1470@item show version
1471Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1472information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1473@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1474version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1475commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1476system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1477variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1478The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1479@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1480
1481@kindex show copying
1482@item show copying
1483Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1484
1485@kindex show warranty
1486@item show warranty
2df3850c 1487Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1488if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1489
c906108c
SS
1490@end table
1491
6d2ebf8b 1492@node Running
c906108c
SS
1493@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1494
1495When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1496debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1497
1498You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1499of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1500your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1501kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1502
1503@menu
1504* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1505* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1506* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1507* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1508
1509* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1510* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1511* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1512* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1513
1514* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1515* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1516@end menu
1517
6d2ebf8b 1518@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1519@section Compiling for debugging
1520
1521In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1522debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1523is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1524variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1525and addresses in the executable code.
1526
1527To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1528the compiler.
1529
1530Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1531options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1532executables containing debugging information.
1533
53a5351d
JM
1534@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1535without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1536recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1537program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1538in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1539
1540@cindex optimized code, debugging
1541@cindex debugging optimized code
1542When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1543optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1544really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1545exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1546variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1547variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1548
1549Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1550@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1551doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1552please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1553
1554Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1555@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1556format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1557
1558@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1559@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1560@section Starting your program
1561@cindex starting
1562@cindex running
1563
1564@table @code
1565@kindex run
41afff9a 1566@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1567@item run
1568@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1569Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1570You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1571argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1572@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1573(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1574
1575@end table
1576
c906108c
SS
1577If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1578supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1579that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1580@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1581
1582The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1583receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1584information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1585can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1586your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1587divided into four categories:
1588
1589@table @asis
1590@item The @emph{arguments.}
1591Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1592@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1593is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1594(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1595the arguments.
1596In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1597@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1598@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1599
1600@item The @emph{environment.}
1601Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1602use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1603environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1604your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1605
1606@item The @emph{working directory.}
1607Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1608the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1609@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1610
1611@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1612Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1613standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1614in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1615set a different device for your program.
1616@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1617
1618@cindex pipes
1619@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1620pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1621program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1622wrong program.
1623@end table
c906108c
SS
1624
1625When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1626immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1627of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1628stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1629or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1630
1631If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1632time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1633table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1634your current breakpoints.
1635
6d2ebf8b 1636@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1637@section Your program's arguments
1638
1639@cindex arguments (to your program)
1640The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1641@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1642They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1643performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1644@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1645@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1646the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1647
1648On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1649@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1650calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1651the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1652
1653@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1654@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1655
c906108c 1656@table @code
41afff9a 1657@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1658@item set args
1659Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1660@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1661with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1662using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1663it again without arguments.
1664
1665@kindex show args
1666@item show args
1667Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1668@end table
1669
6d2ebf8b 1670@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1671@section Your program's environment
1672
1673@cindex environment (of your program)
1674The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1675their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1676your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1677path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1678the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1679debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1680environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1681
1682@table @code
1683@kindex path
1684@item path @var{directory}
1685Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1686(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1687The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1688You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1689system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1690MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1691is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1692
1693You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1694working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1695use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1696@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1697@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1698@var{directory} to the search path.
1699@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1700@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1701
1702@kindex show paths
1703@item show paths
1704Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1705environment variable).
1706
1707@kindex show environment
1708@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1709Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1710your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1711print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1712your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1713
1714@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1715@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1716Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1717changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1718be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1719any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1720parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1721null value.
1722@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1723@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1724
1725For example, this command:
1726
1727@example
1728set env USER = foo
1729@end example
1730
1731@noindent
d4f3574e 1732tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1733@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1734are not actually required.)
1735
1736@kindex unset environment
1737@item unset environment @var{varname}
1738Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1739program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1740@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1741rather than assigning it an empty value.
1742@end table
1743
d4f3574e
SS
1744@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1745the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1746by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1747@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1748that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1749@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1750your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1751files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1752@file{.profile}.
1753
6d2ebf8b 1754@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1755@section Your program's working directory
1756
1757@cindex working directory (of your program)
1758Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1759working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1760The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1761from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1762working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1763
1764The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1765that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1766specify files}.
1767
1768@table @code
1769@kindex cd
1770@item cd @var{directory}
1771Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1772
1773@kindex pwd
1774@item pwd
1775Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1776@end table
1777
6d2ebf8b 1778@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1779@section Your program's input and output
1780
1781@cindex redirection
1782@cindex i/o
1783@cindex terminal
1784By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1785the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1786to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1787modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1788running your program.
1789
1790@table @code
1791@kindex info terminal
1792@item info terminal
1793Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1794program is using.
1795@end table
1796
1797You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1798redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1799
1800@example
1801run > outfile
1802@end example
1803
1804@noindent
1805starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1806
1807@kindex tty
1808@cindex controlling terminal
1809Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1810with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1811argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1812commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1813process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1814
1815@example
1816tty /dev/ttyb
1817@end example
1818
1819@noindent
1820directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1821default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1822that as their controlling terminal.
1823
1824An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1825effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1826terminal.
1827
1828When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1829command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1830for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1831
6d2ebf8b 1832@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1833@section Debugging an already-running process
1834@kindex attach
1835@cindex attach
1836
1837@table @code
1838@item attach @var{process-id}
1839This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1840outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1841targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1842find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1843or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1844
1845@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1846executing the command.
1847@end table
1848
1849To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1850which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1851programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1852also have permission to send the process a signal.
1853
1854When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1855the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1856the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1857(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1858the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1859Specify Files}.
1860
1861The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1862process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1863with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1864you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1865can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1866process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1867attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1868
1869@table @code
1870@kindex detach
1871@item detach
1872When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1873@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1874the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1875that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1876are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1877@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1878executing the command.
1879@end table
1880
1881If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1882attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1883for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1884control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1885confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1886messages}).
1887
6d2ebf8b 1888@node Kill Process
c906108c 1889@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1890
1891@table @code
1892@kindex kill
1893@item kill
1894Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1895@end table
1896
1897This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1898running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1899is running.
1900
1901On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1902while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1903@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1904outside the debugger.
1905
1906The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1907relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1908executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1909next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1910reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1911breakpoint settings).
1912
6d2ebf8b 1913@node Threads
c906108c 1914@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1915
1916@cindex threads of execution
1917@cindex multiple threads
1918@cindex switching threads
1919In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1920may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1921of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1922the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1923that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1924modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1925registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1926
1927@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1928programs:
1929
1930@itemize @bullet
1931@item automatic notification of new threads
1932@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1933@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 1934@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
1935a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1936@item thread-specific breakpoints
1937@end itemize
1938
c906108c
SS
1939@quotation
1940@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1941@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1942If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1943effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1944from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1945like this:
1946
1947@smallexample
1948(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1949(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1950Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1951see the IDs of currently known threads.
1952@end smallexample
1953@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1954@c doesn't support threads"?
1955@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1956
1957@cindex focus of debugging
1958@cindex current thread
1959The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1960threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1961control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1962This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1963program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1964
41afff9a 1965@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
1966@cindex thread identifier (system)
1967@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1968@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1969@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1970Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1971the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1972form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1973whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1974LynxOS, you might see
1975
1976@example
1977[New process 35 thread 27]
1978@end example
1979
1980@noindent
1981when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1982the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1983further qualifier.
1984
1985@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1986@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1987@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1988@c program?
1989@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1990@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 1991@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
1992
1993@cindex thread number
1994@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1995For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1996number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1997
1998@table @code
1999@kindex info threads
2000@item info threads
2001Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2002program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2003
2004@enumerate
2005@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2006
2007@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2008
2009@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2010@end enumerate
2011
2012@noindent
2013An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2014indicates the current thread.
2015
5d161b24 2016For example,
c906108c
SS
2017@end table
2018@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2019
2020@smallexample
2021(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2022 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2023 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2024* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2025 at threadtest.c:68
2026@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2027
2028On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2029
2030@cindex thread number
2031@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2032For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2033number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2034thread in your program.
2035
41afff9a
EZ
2036@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2037@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2038@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2039@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2040@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2041Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2042both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2043form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2044whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2045HP-UX, you see
2046
2047@example
2048[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2049@end example
2050
2051@noindent
5d161b24 2052when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2053
2054@table @code
2055@kindex info threads
2056@item info threads
2057Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2058program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2059
2060@enumerate
2061@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2062
2063@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2064
2065@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2066@end enumerate
2067
2068@noindent
2069An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2070indicates the current thread.
2071
5d161b24 2072For example,
c906108c
SS
2073@end table
2074@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2075
2076@example
2077(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2078 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2079 at quicksort.c:137
2080 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2081 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2082 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2083 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2084@end example
c906108c
SS
2085
2086@table @code
2087@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2088@item thread @var{threadno}
2089Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2090argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2091shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2092@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2093you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2094
2095@smallexample
2096@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2097(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2098[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
20990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2100@end smallexample
2101
2102@noindent
2103As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2104@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2105threads.
c906108c
SS
2106
2107@kindex thread apply
2108@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2109The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2110more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2111with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2112@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2113threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2114@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2115@end table
2116
2117@cindex automatic thread selection
2118@cindex switching threads automatically
2119@cindex threads, automatic switching
2120Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2121signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2122signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2123message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2124thread.
2125
2126@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2127more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2128programs with multiple threads.
2129
2130@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2131watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2132
6d2ebf8b 2133@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2134@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2135
2136@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2137@cindex multiple processes
2138@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2139On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2140programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2141function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2142parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2143set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2144will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2145will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2146
2147However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2148which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2149the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2150only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2151so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2152on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2153get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2154@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2155the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2156the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2157
53a5351d
JM
2158On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2159debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2160@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2161
2162By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2163the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2164
2165If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2166use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2167
2168@table @code
2169@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2170@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2171Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2172@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2173process. The @var{mode} can be:
2174
2175@table @code
2176@item parent
2177The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2178unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2179
2180@item child
2181The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2182unimpeded.
2183
2184@item ask
2185The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2186@end table
2187
2188@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2189Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2190@end table
2191
2192If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2193@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2194breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2195@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2196the child process's @code{main}.
2197
2198When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2199child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2200
2201If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2202call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2203use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2204argument.
2205
2206You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2207a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2208Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2209
6d2ebf8b 2210@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2211@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2212
2213The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2214program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2215trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2216
7a292a7a
SS
2217Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2218such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2219@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2220change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2221continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2222ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2223explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2224
2225@table @code
2226@kindex info program
2227@item info program
2228Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2229running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2230@end table
2231
2232@menu
2233* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2234* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2235* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2236* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2237@end menu
2238
6d2ebf8b 2239@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2240@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2241
2242@cindex breakpoints
2243A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2244the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2245control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2246breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2247Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2248should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2249program.
2250
2251In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2252breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2253a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2254is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2255not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2256arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2257
2258@cindex watchpoints
2259@cindex memory tracing
2260@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2261@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2262A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2263when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2264command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2265watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2266any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2267and watchpoints using the same commands.
2268
2269You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2270whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2271Automatic display}.
2272
2273@cindex catchpoints
2274@cindex breakpoint on events
2275A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2276when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2277exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2278different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2279catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2280other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2281@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2282
2283@cindex breakpoint numbers
2284@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2285@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2286catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2287starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2288features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2289breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2290@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2291enable it again.
2292
c5394b80
JM
2293@cindex breakpoint ranges
2294@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2295Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2296operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2297@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2298hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2299all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2300
c906108c
SS
2301@menu
2302* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2303* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2304* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2305* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2306* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2307* Conditions:: Break conditions
2308* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2309* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2310* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2311@end menu
2312
6d2ebf8b 2313@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2314@subsection Setting breakpoints
2315
5d161b24 2316@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2317@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2318@c
2319@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2320
2321@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2322@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2323@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2324@cindex latest breakpoint
2325Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2326@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2327number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2328Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2329convenience variables.
2330
2331You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2332
2333@table @code
2334@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2335Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2336When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2337C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2338@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2339
2340@item break +@var{offset}
2341@itemx break -@var{offset}
2342Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2343at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2344(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2345
2346@item break @var{linenum}
2347Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2348The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2349The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2350code on that line.
2351
2352@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2353Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2354
2355@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2356Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2357@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2358superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2359functions.
2360
2361@item break *@var{address}
2362Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2363breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2364information or source files.
2365
2366@item break
2367When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2368the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2369(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2370innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2371returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2372@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2373that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2374@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2375the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2376inside loops.
2377
2378@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2379least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2380would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2381breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2382existed when your program stopped.
2383
2384@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2385Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2386@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2387value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2388@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2389above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2390,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2391
2392@kindex tbreak
2393@item tbreak @var{args}
2394Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2395same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2396way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2397program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2398
c906108c
SS
2399@kindex hbreak
2400@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2401Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2402@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2403breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2404have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2405debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2406changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2407provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2408will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2409address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2410breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2411example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2412@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2413or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2414(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2415
2416@kindex thbreak
2417@item thbreak @var{args}
2418Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2419are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2420the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2421the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2422first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2423command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2424may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2425See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2426
2427@kindex rbreak
2428@cindex regular expression
2429@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2430Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2431@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2432matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2433breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2434the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2435them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2436
2437The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2438like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2439shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2440an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2441@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2442match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2443
b37052ae 2444When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2445breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2446classes.
c906108c
SS
2447
2448@kindex info breakpoints
2449@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2450@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2451@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2452@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2453Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2454not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2455
2456@table @emph
2457@item Breakpoint Numbers
2458@item Type
2459Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2460@item Disposition
2461Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2462@item Enabled or Disabled
2463Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2464that are not enabled.
2465@item Address
2df3850c 2466Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2467@item What
2468Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2469line number.
2470@end table
2471
2472@noindent
2473If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2474the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2475are listed after that.
2476
2477@noindent
2478@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2479number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2480convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2481the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2482listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2483
2484@noindent
2485@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2486has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2487@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2488hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2489was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2490will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2491@end table
2492
2493@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2494your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2495the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2496(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2497
2498@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2499@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2500@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2501purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2502These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2503@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2504
2505You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2506@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2507
2508@table @code
2509@kindex maint info breakpoints
2510@item maint info breakpoints
2511Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2512breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2513internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2514breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2515is shown:
2516
2517@table @code
2518@item breakpoint
2519Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2520
2521@item watchpoint
2522Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2523
2524@item longjmp
2525Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2526@code{longjmp} calls.
2527
2528@item longjmp resume
2529Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2530
2531@item until
2532Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2533
2534@item finish
2535Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2536
c906108c
SS
2537@item shlib events
2538Shared library events.
53a5351d 2539
c906108c 2540@end table
53a5351d 2541
c906108c
SS
2542@end table
2543
2544
6d2ebf8b 2545@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2546@subsection Setting watchpoints
2547
2548@cindex setting watchpoints
2549@cindex software watchpoints
2550@cindex hardware watchpoints
2551You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2552expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2553this may happen.
2554
2555Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2556hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2557program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2558times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2559catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2560culprit.)
2561
d4f3574e 2562On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2563@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2564hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2565program.
2566
2567@table @code
2568@kindex watch
2569@item watch @var{expr}
2570Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2571is written into by the program and its value changes.
2572
2573@kindex rwatch
2574@item rwatch @var{expr}
2575Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2576
2577@kindex awatch
2578@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2579Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2580by the program.
c906108c
SS
2581
2582@kindex info watchpoints
2583@item info watchpoints
2584This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2585it is the same as @code{info break}.
2586@end table
2587
2588@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2589watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2590value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2591cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2592executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2593statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2594
2595When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2596
2597@example
2598Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2599@end example
2600
2601@noindent
2602if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2603
7be570e7
JM
2604Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2605hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2606value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2607every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2608that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2609hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2610will print a message like this:
2611
2612@smallexample
2613Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2614@end smallexample
2615
2616Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2617data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2618watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2619can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2620cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2621double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2622wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2623into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2624
2625If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2626to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2627Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2628time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2629able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2630warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2631
2632@smallexample
2633Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2634@end smallexample
2635
2636@noindent
2637If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2638
2639The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2640or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2641data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2642hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2643both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2644watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2645@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2646watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2647@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2648Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2649
2650If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2651any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2652kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2653
7be570e7
JM
2654@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2655(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2656they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2657which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2658being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2659and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2660rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2661way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2662@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2663
c906108c
SS
2664@quotation
2665@cindex watchpoints and threads
2666@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2667@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2668usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2669can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2670you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2671thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2672can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2673@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2674the expression.
53a5351d 2675
d4f3574e 2676@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2677@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2678have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2679watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2680single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2681change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2682confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2683software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2684when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2685watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2686@end quotation
c906108c 2687
6d2ebf8b 2688@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2689@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2690@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2691@cindex exception handlers
2692@cindex event handling
2693
2694You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2695kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2696shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2697
2698@table @code
2699@kindex catch
2700@item catch @var{event}
2701Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2702@table @code
2703@item throw
2704@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2705The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2706
2707@item catch
2708@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2709The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2710
2711@item exec
2712@kindex catch exec
2713A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2714
2715@item fork
2716@kindex catch fork
2717A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2718
2719@item vfork
2720@kindex catch vfork
2721A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2722
2723@item load
2724@itemx load @var{libname}
2725@kindex catch load
2726The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2727@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2728
2729@item unload
2730@itemx unload @var{libname}
2731@kindex catch unload
2732The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2733of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2734@end table
2735
2736@item tcatch @var{event}
2737Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2738automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2739
2740@end table
2741
2742Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2743
b37052ae 2744There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2745(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2746
2747@itemize @bullet
2748@item
2749If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2750control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2751raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2752returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2753simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2754that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2755you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2756disabled within interactive calls.
2757
2758@item
2759You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2760
2761@item
2762You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2763@end itemize
2764
2765@cindex raise exceptions
2766Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2767if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2768stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2769can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2770breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2771out where the exception was raised.
2772
2773To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2774knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2775raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2776which has the following ANSI C interface:
2777
2778@example
2779 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2780 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2781 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2782@end example
2783
2784@noindent
2785To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2786unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2787(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2788
2789With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2790that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2791a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2792breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2793raised.
2794
2795
6d2ebf8b 2796@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2797@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2798
2799@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2800@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2801It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2802catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2803to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2804breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2805
2806With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2807where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2808delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2809their breakpoint numbers.
2810
2811It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2812automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2813when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2814
2815@table @code
2816@kindex clear
2817@item clear
2818Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2819selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2820the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2821breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2822
2823@item clear @var{function}
2824@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2825Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2826
2827@item clear @var{linenum}
2828@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2829Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2830
2831@cindex delete breakpoints
2832@kindex delete
41afff9a 2833@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2834@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2835Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2836ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2837breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2838confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2839@end table
2840
6d2ebf8b 2841@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2842@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2843
2844@kindex disable breakpoints
2845@kindex enable breakpoints
2846Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2847prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2848it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2849that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2850
2851You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2852the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2853or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2854@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2855catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2856
2857A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2858states of enablement:
2859
2860@itemize @bullet
2861@item
2862Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2863with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2864@item
2865Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2866@item
2867Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2868disabled.
c906108c
SS
2869@item
2870Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2871immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2872set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2873@end itemize
2874
2875You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2876watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex disable breakpoints
2880@kindex disable
41afff9a 2881@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2882@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2883Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2884listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2885options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2886case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2887@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2888
2889@kindex enable breakpoints
2890@kindex enable
c5394b80 2891@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2892Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2893become effective once again in stopping your program.
2894
c5394b80 2895@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2896Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2897of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2898
c5394b80 2899@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2900Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2901deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2902@end table
2903
d4f3574e
SS
2904@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2905@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2906Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2907,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2908subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2909the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2910breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2911breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2912stepping}.)
2913
6d2ebf8b 2914@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2915@subsection Break conditions
2916@cindex conditional breakpoints
2917@cindex breakpoint conditions
2918
2919@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2920@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2921The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2922specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2923breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2924programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2925a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2926and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2927
2928This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2929situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2930when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2931by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2932@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2933
2934Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2935since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2936it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2937and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2938one.
2939
2940Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2941your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2942that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2943format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2944unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2945that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2946program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2947breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2948conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2949purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2950(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2951
2952Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2953@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2954Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2955with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2956
c906108c
SS
2957You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2958The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2959@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2960catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2961
2962@table @code
2963@kindex condition
2964@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2965Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2966watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2967breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2968@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2969@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2970syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2971referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2972symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2973prints an error message:
2974
2975@example
2976No symbol "foo" in current context.
2977@end example
2978
2979@noindent
c906108c
SS
2980@value{GDBN} does
2981not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2982command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2983@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2984
2985@item condition @var{bnum}
2986Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2987an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2988@end table
2989
2990@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2991A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2992breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2993useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2994count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2995is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2996therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2997ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2998the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2999value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3000your program reaches it.
3001
3002@table @code
3003@kindex ignore
3004@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3005Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3006The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3007execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3008takes no action.
3009
3010To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3011a count of zero.
3012
3013When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3014breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3015@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3016Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3017
3018If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3019condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3020@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3021
3022You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3023as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3024is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3025variables}.
3026@end table
3027
3028Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3029
3030
6d2ebf8b 3031@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3032@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3033
3034@cindex breakpoint commands
3035You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3036commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3037example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3038enable other breakpoints.
3039
3040@table @code
3041@kindex commands
3042@kindex end
3043@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3044@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3045@itemx end
3046Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3047themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3048@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3049
3050To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3051follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3052
3053With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3054breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3055recently encountered).
3056@end table
3057
3058Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3059disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3060
3061You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3062use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3063that resumes execution.
3064
3065Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3066execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3067(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3068another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3069ambiguities about which list to execute.
3070
3071@kindex silent
3072If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3073usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3074be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3075then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3076see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3077meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3078
3079The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3080print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3081breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3082
3083For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3084value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3085
3086@example
3087break foo if x>0
3088commands
3089silent
3090printf "x is %d\n",x
3091cont
3092end
3093@end example
3094
3095One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3096you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3097of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3098erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3099to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3100so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3101command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3102
3103@example
3104break 403
3105commands
3106silent
3107set x = y + 4
3108cont
3109end
3110@end example
3111
6d2ebf8b 3112@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3113@subsection Breakpoint menus
3114@cindex overloading
3115@cindex symbol overloading
3116
b37052ae 3117Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3118to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3119This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3120@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3121a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3122something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3123particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3124you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3125waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3126options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3127sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3128@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3129breakpoints.
3130
3131For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3132breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3133We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3134
3135@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3136@smallexample
3137@group
3138(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3139[0] cancel
3140[1] all
3141[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3142[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3143[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3144[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3145[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3146[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3147> 2 4 6
3148Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3149Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3150Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3151Multiple breakpoints were set.
3152Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3153 breakpoints.
3154(@value{GDBP})
3155@end group
3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3159@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3160@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3161@c
3162@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3163@c
d4f3574e
SS
3164Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3165any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3166attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3167@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3168
3169@example
3170Cannot insert breakpoints.
3171The same program may be running in another process.
3172@end example
3173
3174When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3175
3176@enumerate
3177@item
3178Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3179
3180@item
5d161b24 3181Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3182name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3183that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3184Then start your program again.
3185
3186@item
3187Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3188linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3189to nonsharable executables.
3190@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3191@c @end ifclear
3192
d4f3574e
SS
3193A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3194hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3195
3196@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3197@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3198@smallexample
3199Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3200You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3201@end smallexample
3202
3203@noindent
3204This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3205only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3206watchpoints it needs to insert.
3207
3208When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3209hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3210
3211
6d2ebf8b 3212@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3213@section Continuing and stepping
3214
3215@cindex stepping
3216@cindex continuing
3217@cindex resuming execution
3218@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3219completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3220one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3221line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3222particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3223your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3224it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3225@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3226
3227@table @code
3228@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3229@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3230@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3231@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3232@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3233@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3234Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3235any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3236@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3237ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3238@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3239
3240The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3241stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3242@code{continue} is ignored.
3243
d4f3574e
SS
3244The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3245debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3246purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3247@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3248@end table
3249
3250To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3251(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3252calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3253different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3254
3255A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3256(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3257beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3258is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3259and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3260interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3261
3262@table @code
3263@kindex step
41afff9a 3264@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3265@item step
3266Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3267line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3268abbreviated @code{s}.
3269
3270@quotation
3271@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3272@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3273@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3274@c distinction here.
3275@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3276within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3277execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3278debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3279is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3280without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3281below.
3282@end quotation
3283
4a92d011
EZ
3284The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3285line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3286@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3287to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3288the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3289called within the line.
c906108c 3290
d4f3574e
SS
3291Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3292number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3293@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3294on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3295was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3296
3297@item step @var{count}
3298Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3299breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3300@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3301
3302@kindex next
41afff9a 3303@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3304@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3305Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3306This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3307the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3308control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3309that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3310is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3311
3312An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3313
3314
3315@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3316@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3317@c
3318@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3319@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3320@c function are executed without stopping.
3321
d4f3574e
SS
3322The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3323source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3324@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3325
b90a5f51
CF
3326@kindex set step-mode
3327@item set step-mode
3328@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3329@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3330@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3331The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3332stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3333information rather than stepping over it.
3334
4a92d011
EZ
3335This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3336machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3337want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3338
3339@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3340Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3341debug information. This is the default.
3342
c906108c
SS
3343@kindex finish
3344@item finish
3345Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3346returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3347
3348Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3349,Returning from a function}).
3350
3351@kindex until
41afff9a 3352@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3353@item until
3354@itemx u
3355Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3356current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3357stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3358command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3359automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3360than the address of the jump.
3361
3362This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3363though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3364exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3365simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3366through the next iteration.
3367
3368@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3369stack frame.
3370
3371@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3372of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3373example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3374(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3375@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3376
3377@example
3378(@value{GDBP}) f
3379#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3380206 expand_input();
3381(@value{GDBP}) until
3382195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3383@end example
3384
3385This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3386generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3387start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3388written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3389to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3390expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3391statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3392
3393@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3394instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3395argument.
3396
3397@item until @var{location}
3398@itemx u @var{location}
3399Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3400reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3401the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3402,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3403and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3404
3405@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3406@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3407@item stepi
96a2c332 3408@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3409@itemx si
3410Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3411
3412It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3413instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3414instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3415Display,, Automatic display}.
3416
3417An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3418
3419@need 750
3420@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3421@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3422@item nexti
96a2c332 3423@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3424@itemx ni
3425Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3426proceed until the function returns.
3427
3428An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3429@end table
3430
6d2ebf8b 3431@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3432@section Signals
3433@cindex signals
3434
3435A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3436operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3437kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3438signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3439@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3440memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3441the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3442requested an alarm).
3443
3444@cindex fatal signals
3445Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3446functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3447errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3448program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3449@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3450fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3451
3452@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3453program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3454signal.
3455
3456@cindex handling signals
3457Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3458(so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3459but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3460You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3461
3462@table @code
3463@kindex info signals
3464@item info signals
96a2c332 3465@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3466Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3467handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3468the defined types of signals.
3469
d4f3574e 3470@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3471
3472@kindex handle
3473@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3474Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3475can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3476@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numberss of the form
3477@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3478known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3479@end table
3480
3481@c @group
3482The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3483Their full names are:
3484
3485@table @code
3486@item nostop
3487@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3488still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3489
3490@item stop
3491@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3492the @code{print} keyword as well.
3493
3494@item print
3495@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3496
3497@item noprint
3498@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3499implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3500
3501@item pass
5ece1a18 3502@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3503@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3504can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3505and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3506
3507@item nopass
5ece1a18 3508@itemx ignore
c906108c 3509@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3510@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3511@end table
3512@c @end group
3513
d4f3574e
SS
3514When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3515program until you
c906108c
SS
3516continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3517effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3518after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3519command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3520program sees that signal when you continue.
3521
3522You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3523seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3524or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3525due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3526values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3527execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3528a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3529you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3530program a signal}.
c906108c 3531
6d2ebf8b 3532@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3533@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3534
3535When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3536programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3537breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3538
3539@table @code
3540@cindex breakpoints and threads
3541@cindex thread breakpoints
3542@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3543@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3544@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3545@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3546writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3547
3548Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3549to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3550particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3551numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3552column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3553
3554If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3555breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3556program.
3557
3558You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3559well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3560breakpoint condition, like this:
3561
3562@smallexample
2df3850c 3563(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3564@end smallexample
3565
3566@end table
3567
3568@cindex stopped threads
3569@cindex threads, stopped
3570Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3571@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3572allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3573switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3574underfoot.
3575
3576@cindex continuing threads
3577@cindex threads, continuing
3578Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3579executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3580like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3581
3582In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3583Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3584system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3585execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3586single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3587statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3588stops.
3589
3590You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3591continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3592thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3593first thread completes whatever you requested.
3594
3595On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3596thread to run.
3597
3598@table @code
3599@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3600Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3601locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3602current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3603mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3604``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3605stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3606when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3607function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3608like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3609thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3610@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3611
3612@item show scheduler-locking
3613Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3614@end table
3615
c906108c 3616
6d2ebf8b 3617@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3618@chapter Examining the Stack
3619
3620When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3621stopped and how it got there.
3622
3623@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3624Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3625is generated.
3626That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3627the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3628and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3629The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3630The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3631stack}.
3632
3633When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3634stack allow you to see all of this information.
3635
3636@cindex selected frame
3637One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3638@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3639particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3640your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3641special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3642interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3643
3644When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3645currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3646@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3647
3648@menu
3649* Frames:: Stack frames
3650* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3651* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3652* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3653
3654@end menu
3655
6d2ebf8b 3656@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3657@section Stack frames
3658
d4f3574e 3659@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3660@cindex stack frame
3661The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3662frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3663with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3664to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3665which the function is executing.
3666
3667@cindex initial frame
3668@cindex outermost frame
3669@cindex innermost frame
3670When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3671function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3672@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3673made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3674is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3675the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3676actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3677recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3678
3679@cindex frame pointer
3680Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3681stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3682kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3683address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3684in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3685going on in that frame.
3686
3687@cindex frame number
3688@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3689zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3690and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3691they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3692frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3693
6d2ebf8b
SS
3694@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3695@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3696@cindex frameless execution
3697Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3698without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3699@example
3700@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3701@end example
3702generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3703This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3704the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3705with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3706has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3707it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3708correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3709no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3710
3711@table @code
d4f3574e 3712@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3713@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3714@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3715The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3716and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3717address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3718@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3719
3720@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3721@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3722@item select-frame
3723The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3724to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3725@code{frame}.
3726@end table
3727
6d2ebf8b 3728@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3729@section Backtraces
3730
3731@cindex backtraces
3732@cindex tracebacks
3733@cindex stack traces
3734A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3735line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3736frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3737stack.
3738
3739@table @code
3740@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3741@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3742@item backtrace
3743@itemx bt
3744Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3745frames in the stack.
3746
3747You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3748character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3749
3750@item backtrace @var{n}
3751@itemx bt @var{n}
3752Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3753
3754@item backtrace -@var{n}
3755@itemx bt -@var{n}
3756Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3757@end table
3758
3759@kindex where
3760@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3761@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3762The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3763are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3764
3765Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3766The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3767print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3768line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3769counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3770line number.
3771
3772Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3773@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3774
3775@smallexample
3776@group
5d161b24 3777#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3778 at builtin.c:993
3779#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3780#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3781 at macro.c:71
3782(More stack frames follow...)
3783@end group
3784@end smallexample
3785
3786@noindent
3787The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3788value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3789code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3790
6d2ebf8b 3791@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3792@section Selecting a frame
3793
3794Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3795whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3796selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3797of the stack frame just selected.
3798
3799@table @code
d4f3574e 3800@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3801@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3802@item frame @var{n}
3803@itemx f @var{n}
3804Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3805(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3806innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3807@code{main}.
3808
3809@item frame @var{addr}
3810@itemx f @var{addr}
3811Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3812chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3813impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3814addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3815switches between them.
3816
c906108c
SS
3817On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3818select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3819
3820On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3821pointer and a program counter.
3822
3823On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3824pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3825@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3826@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3827@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3828
3829@kindex up
3830@item up @var{n}
3831Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3832advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3833that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3834
3835@kindex down
41afff9a 3836@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3837@item down @var{n}
3838Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3839advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3840that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3841abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3842@end table
3843
3844All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3845frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3846arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3847frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3848
3849@need 1000
3850For example:
3851
3852@smallexample
3853@group
3854(@value{GDBP}) up
3855#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3856 at env.c:10
385710 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3858@end group
3859@end smallexample
3860
3861After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3862prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3863@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3864
3865@table @code
3866@kindex down-silently
3867@kindex up-silently
3868@item up-silently @var{n}
3869@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3870These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3871respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3872causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3873in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3874distracting.
3875@end table
3876
6d2ebf8b 3877@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3878@section Information about a frame
3879
3880There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3881stack frame.
3882
3883@table @code
3884@item frame
3885@itemx f
3886When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3887frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3888selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3889argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3890@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3891
3892@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3893@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3894@item info frame
3895@itemx info f
3896This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3897including:
3898
3899@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3900@item
3901the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3902@item
3903the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3904@item
3905the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3906@item
3907the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3908@item
3909the address of the frame's arguments
3910@item
d4f3574e
SS
3911the address of the frame's local variables
3912@item
c906108c
SS
3913the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3914@item
3915which registers were saved in the frame
3916@end itemize
3917
3918@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3919something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3920the usual conventions.
3921
3922@item info frame @var{addr}
3923@itemx info f @var{addr}
3924Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3925selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3926command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3927architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3928@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3929
3930@kindex info args
3931@item info args
3932Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3933
3934@item info locals
3935@kindex info locals
3936Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3937line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3938accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3939
c906108c 3940@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3941@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3942@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3943@item info catch
3944Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3945current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3946exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3947@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3948@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3949
c906108c
SS
3950@end table
3951
c906108c 3952
6d2ebf8b 3953@node Source
c906108c
SS
3954@chapter Examining Source Files
3955
3956@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3957information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3958used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3959the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3960(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3961execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3962source files by explicit command.
3963
7a292a7a 3964If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3965prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3966@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3967
3968@menu
3969* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3970* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3971* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3972* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3973@end menu
3974
6d2ebf8b 3975@node List
c906108c
SS
3976@section Printing source lines
3977
3978@kindex list
41afff9a 3979@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 3980To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 3981(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
3982There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3983
3984Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3985
3986@table @code
3987@item list @var{linenum}
3988Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3989current source file.
3990
3991@item list @var{function}
3992Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3993@var{function}.
3994
3995@item list
3996Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3997@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3998printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3999as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4000Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4001
4002@item list -
4003Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4004@end table
4005
4006By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4007the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4008
4009@table @code
4010@kindex set listsize
4011@item set listsize @var{count}
4012Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4013the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4014
4015@kindex show listsize
4016@item show listsize
4017Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4018@end table
4019
4020Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4021so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4022than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4023argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4024each repetition moves up in the source file.
4025
4026@cindex linespec
4027In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4028@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4029of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4030Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4031
4032@table @code
4033@item list @var{linespec}
4034Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4035
4036@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4037Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4038linespecs.
4039
4040@item list ,@var{last}
4041Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4042
4043@item list @var{first},
4044Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4045
4046@item list +
4047Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4048
4049@item list -
4050Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4051
4052@item list
4053As described in the preceding table.
4054@end table
4055
4056Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4057kinds of linespec.
4058
4059@table @code
4060@item @var{number}
4061Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4062When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4063the same source file as the first linespec.
4064
4065@item +@var{offset}
4066Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4067When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4068two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4069first linespec.
4070
4071@item -@var{offset}
4072Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4073
4074@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4075Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4076
4077@item @var{function}
4078Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4079For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4080
4081@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4082Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4083function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4084file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4085identically named functions in different source files.
4086
4087@item *@var{address}
4088Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4089@var{address} may be any expression.
4090@end table
4091
6d2ebf8b 4092@node Search
c906108c
SS
4093@section Searching source files
4094@cindex searching
4095@kindex reverse-search
4096
4097There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4098regular expression.
4099
4100@table @code
4101@kindex search
4102@kindex forward-search
4103@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4104@itemx search @var{regexp}
4105The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4106starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4107@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4108synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4109@code{fo}.
4110
4111@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4112The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4113with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4114for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4115this command as @code{rev}.
4116@end table
c906108c 4117
6d2ebf8b 4118@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4119@section Specifying source directories
4120
4121@cindex source path
4122@cindex directories for source files
4123Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4124files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4125the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4126session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4127this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4128it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4129in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4130the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4131the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4132path.
4133
4134If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4135object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4136too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4137compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4138last resort.
4139
4140Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4141any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4142each line is in the file.
4143
4144@kindex directory
4145@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4146When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4147and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4148To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4149
4150@table @code
4151@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4152@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4153Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4154directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4155(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4156part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4157whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4158path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4159
4160@kindex cdir
4161@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4162@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4163@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4164@cindex compilation directory
4165@cindex current directory
4166@cindex working directory
4167@cindex directory, current
4168@cindex directory, compilation
4169You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4170directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4171working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4172tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4173session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4174directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4175
4176@item directory
4177Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4178
4179@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4180@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4181
4182@item show directories
4183@kindex show directories
4184Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4185@end table
4186
4187If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4188interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4189versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4190
4191@enumerate
4192@item
4193Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4194
4195@item
4196Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4197directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4198directories in one command.
4199@end enumerate
4200
6d2ebf8b 4201@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4202@section Source and machine code
4203
4204You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4205addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4206a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4207mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4208line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4209well as hex.
4210
4211@table @code
4212@kindex info line
4213@item info line @var{linespec}
4214Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4215source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4216the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4217source lines}).
4218@end table
4219
4220For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4221the object code for the first line of function
4222@code{m4_changequote}:
4223
d4f3574e
SS
4224@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4225@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4226@smallexample
96a2c332 4227(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4228Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4229@end smallexample
4230
4231@noindent
4232We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4233@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4234@smallexample
4235(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4236Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4237@end smallexample
4238
4239@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4240@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4241After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4242is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4243sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4244,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4245convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4246variables}).
4247
4248@table @code
4249@kindex disassemble
4250@cindex assembly instructions
4251@cindex instructions, assembly
4252@cindex machine instructions
4253@cindex listing machine instructions
4254@item disassemble
4255This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4256instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4257program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4258command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4259surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4260(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4261@end table
4262
c906108c
SS
4263The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4264HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4265
4266@smallexample
4267(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4268Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
42690x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
42700x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
42710x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
42720x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
42730x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
42740x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
42750x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
42760x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4277End of assembler dump.
4278@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4279
4280Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4281mnemonics or other syntax.
4282
4283@table @code
d4f3574e 4284@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4285@cindex assembly instructions
4286@cindex instructions, assembly
4287@cindex machine instructions
4288@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4289@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4290@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4291@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4292Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4293program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4294
4295Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4296can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4297The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4298assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4299@end table
4300
4301
6d2ebf8b 4302@node Data
c906108c
SS
4303@chapter Examining Data
4304
4305@cindex printing data
4306@cindex examining data
4307@kindex print
4308@kindex inspect
4309@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4310@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4311@c different window or something like that.
4312The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4313command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4314evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4315program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4316Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4317
4318@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4319@item print @var{expr}
4320@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4321@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4322value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4323you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4324@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4325formats}.
4326
4327@item print
4328@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4329If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4330@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4331conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4332@end table
4333
4334A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4335It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4336specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4337
7a292a7a 4338If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4339fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4340command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4341Table}.
c906108c
SS
4342
4343@menu
4344* Expressions:: Expressions
4345* Variables:: Program variables
4346* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4347* Output Formats:: Output formats
4348* Memory:: Examining memory
4349* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4350* Print Settings:: Print settings
4351* Value History:: Value history
4352* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4353* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4354* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4355* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
c906108c
SS
4356@end menu
4357
6d2ebf8b 4358@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4359@section Expressions
4360
4361@cindex expressions
4362@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4363compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4364by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4365@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4366and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4367by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4368
d4f3574e
SS
4369@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4370the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4371you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4372memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4373
c906108c
SS
4374Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4375this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4376Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4377languages.
4378
4379In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4380expressions regardless of your programming language.
4381
4382Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4383useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4384at that address in memory.
4385@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4386
4387@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4388to programming languages:
4389
4390@table @code
4391@item @@
4392@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4393@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4394
4395@item ::
4396@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4397function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4398
4399@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4400@cindex type casting memory
4401@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4402@cindex casts, to view memory
4403@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4404Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4405memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4406pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4407a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4408normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4409@end table
4410
6d2ebf8b 4411@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4412@section Program variables
4413
4414The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4415in your program.
4416
4417Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4418(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4419
4420@itemize @bullet
4421@item
4422global (or file-static)
4423@end itemize
4424
5d161b24 4425@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4426
4427@itemize @bullet
4428@item
4429visible according to the scope rules of the
4430programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4431@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4432
4433@noindent This means that in the function
4434
4435@example
4436foo (a)
4437 int a;
4438@{
4439 bar (a);
4440 @{
4441 int b = test ();
4442 bar (b);
4443 @}
4444@}
4445@end example
4446
4447@noindent
4448you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4449executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4450examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4451the block where @code{b} is declared.
4452
4453@cindex variable name conflict
4454There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4455scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4456in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4457function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4458happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4459you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4460using the colon-colon notation:
4461
d4f3574e 4462@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4463@iftex
4464@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4465@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4466@end iftex
4467@example
4468@var{file}::@var{variable}
4469@var{function}::@var{variable}
4470@end example
4471
4472@noindent
4473Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4474static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4475make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4476to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4477
4478@example
4479(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4480@end example
4481
b37052ae 4482@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4483This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4484use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4485scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4486@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4487@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4488
4489@cindex wrong values
4490@cindex variable values, wrong
4491@quotation
4492@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4493wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4494scope, and just before exit.
4495@end quotation
4496You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4497This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4498set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4499stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4500values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4501also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4502after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4503variable definitions may be gone.
4504
4505This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4506To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4507when compiling.
4508
d4f3574e
SS
4509@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4510Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4511unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4512opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4513offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4514might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4515happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4516
4517@example
4518No symbol "foo" in current context.
4519@end example
4520
4521To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4522different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4523formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4524supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4525in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4526to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4527debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4528Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4529information.
4530
4531
6d2ebf8b 4532@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4533@section Artificial arrays
4534
4535@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4536@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4537It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4538same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4539dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4540program.
4541
4542You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4543@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4544operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4545and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4546of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4547the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4548argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4549following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4550example. If a program says
4551
4552@example
4553int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4554@end example
4555
4556@noindent
4557you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4558
4559@example
4560p *array@@len
4561@end example
4562
4563The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4564with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4565subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4566Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4567(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4568
4569Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4570This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4571The value need not be in memory:
4572@example
4573(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4574$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4575@end example
4576
4577As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4578@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4579the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4580@example
4581(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4582$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4583@end example
4584
4585Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4586moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4587actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4588of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4589to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4590variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4591interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4592instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4593structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4594in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4595
4596@example
4597set $i = 0
4598p dtab[$i++]->fv
4599@key{RET}
4600@key{RET}
4601@dots{}
4602@end example
4603
6d2ebf8b 4604@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4605@section Output formats
4606
4607@cindex formatted output
4608@cindex output formats
4609By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4610this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4611in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4612at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4613these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4614
4615The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4616already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4617@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4618letters supported are:
4619
4620@table @code
4621@item x
4622Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4623hexadecimal.
4624
4625@item d
4626Print as integer in signed decimal.
4627
4628@item u
4629Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4630
4631@item o
4632Print as integer in octal.
4633
4634@item t
4635Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4636@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4637used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4638see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4639
4640@item a
4641@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4642@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4643Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4644the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4645where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4646
4647@example
4648(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4649$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4650@end example
4651
3d67e040
EZ
4652@noindent
4653The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4654@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4655
c906108c
SS
4656@item c
4657Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4658
4659@item f
4660Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4661using typical floating point syntax.
4662@end table
4663
4664For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4665
4666@example
4667p/x $pc
4668@end example
4669
4670@noindent
4671Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4672names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4673
4674To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4675you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4676expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4677
6d2ebf8b 4678@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4679@section Examining memory
4680
4681You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4682any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4683
4684@cindex examining memory
4685@table @code
41afff9a 4686@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4687@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4688@itemx x @var{addr}
4689@itemx x
4690Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4691@end table
4692
4693@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4694much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4695expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4696If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4697Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4698
4699@table @r
4700@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4701The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4702how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4703@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4704@c 4.1.2.
4705
4706@item @var{f}, the display format
4707The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4708@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4709The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4710The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4711
4712@item @var{u}, the unit size
4713The unit size is any of
4714
4715@table @code
4716@item b
4717Bytes.
4718@item h
4719Halfwords (two bytes).
4720@item w
4721Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4722@item g
4723Giant words (eight bytes).
4724@end table
4725
4726Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4727default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4728@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4729
4730@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4731@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4732memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4733it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4734@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4735@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4736other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4737the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4738starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4739a value from memory).
4740@end table
4741
4742For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4743(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4744starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4745words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4746@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4747
4748Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4749letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4750unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4751specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4752(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4753
4754Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4755and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4756@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4757including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4758alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4759Code,,Source and machine code}.
4760
4761All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4762easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4763you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4764instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4765with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4766the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4767for successive uses of @code{x}.
4768
4769@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4770The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4771in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4772would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4773subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4774@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4775examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4776@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4777the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4778
4779If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4780are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4781address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4782
6d2ebf8b 4783@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4784@section Automatic display
4785@cindex automatic display
4786@cindex display of expressions
4787
4788If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4789(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4790display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4791Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4792to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4793The automatic display looks like this:
4794
4795@example
47962: foo = 38
47973: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4798@end example
4799
4800@noindent
4801This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4802displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4803specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4804whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4805format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4806or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4807supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4808
4809@table @code
4810@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4811@item display @var{expr}
4812Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4813each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4814
4815@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4816
d4f3574e 4817@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4818For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4819count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4820arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4821@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4822
4823@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4824For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4825number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4826be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4827doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4828@end table
4829
4830For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4831instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4832is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4833
4834@table @code
4835@kindex delete display
4836@kindex undisplay
4837@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4838@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4839Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4840
4841@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4842(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4843
4844@kindex disable display
4845@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4846Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4847item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4848enabled again later.
4849
4850@kindex enable display
4851@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4852Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4853again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4854
4855@item display
4856Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4857done when your program stops.
4858
4859@kindex info display
4860@item info display
4861Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4862automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4863values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4864It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4865because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4866@end table
4867
4868If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4869sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4870expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4871variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4872@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4873@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4874continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4875there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4876automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4877is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4878
6d2ebf8b 4879@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4880@section Print settings
4881
4882@cindex format options
4883@cindex print settings
4884@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4885and symbols are printed.
4886
4887@noindent
4888These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4889
4890@table @code
4891@kindex set print address
4892@item set print address
4893@itemx set print address on
4894@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4895traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4896even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4897is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4898@code{set print address on}:
4899
4900@smallexample
4901@group
4902(@value{GDBP}) f
4903#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4904 at input.c:530
4905530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4906@end group
4907@end smallexample
4908
4909@item set print address off
4910Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4911this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4912
4913@smallexample
4914@group
4915(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4916(@value{GDBP}) f
4917#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4918530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4919@end group
4920@end smallexample
4921
4922You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4923dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4924@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4925all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4926
4927@kindex show print address
4928@item show print address
4929Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4930@end table
4931
4932When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4933closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4934identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4935source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4936@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4937you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4938it prints a symbolic address:
4939
4940@table @code
4941@kindex set print symbol-filename
4942@item set print symbol-filename on
4943Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4944symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4945
4946@item set print symbol-filename off
4947Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4948default.
4949
4950@kindex show print symbol-filename
4951@item show print symbol-filename
4952Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4953line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4954@end table
4955
4956Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4957numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4958number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4959
4960Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4961printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4962
4963@table @code
4964@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4965@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4966Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4967offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 4968@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
4969to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4970
4971@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4972@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4973Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4974symbolic address.
4975@end table
4976
4977@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4978@cindex pointer, finding referent
4979If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4980@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4981and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4982@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4983For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4984at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4985
4986@example
4987(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4988(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4989$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4990@end example
4991
4992@quotation
4993@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4994does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4995the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4996@end quotation
4997
4998Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4999
5000@table @code
5001@kindex set print array
5002@item set print array
5003@itemx set print array on
5004Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5005but uses more space. The default is off.
5006
5007@item set print array off
5008Return to compressed format for arrays.
5009
5010@kindex show print array
5011@item show print array
5012Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5013arrays.
5014
5015@kindex set print elements
5016@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5017Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5018If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5019printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5020This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5021When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5022Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5023
5024@kindex show print elements
5025@item show print elements
5026Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5027If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5028
5029@kindex set print null-stop
5030@item set print null-stop
5031Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5032@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5033contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5034The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5035
5036@kindex set print pretty
5037@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5038Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5039per line, like this:
5040
5041@smallexample
5042@group
5043$1 = @{
5044 next = 0x0,
5045 flags = @{
5046 sweet = 1,
5047 sour = 1
5048 @},
5049 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5050@}
5051@end group
5052@end smallexample
5053
5054@item set print pretty off
5055Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5056
5057@smallexample
5058@group
5059$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5060meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5061@end group
5062@end smallexample
5063
5064@noindent
5065This is the default format.
5066
5067@kindex show print pretty
5068@item show print pretty
5069Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5070
5071@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5072@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5073Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5074@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5075character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5076best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5077high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5078
5079@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5080Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5081international character sets, and is the default.
5082
5083@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5084@item show print sevenbit-strings
5085Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5086
5087@kindex set print union
5088@item set print union on
5d161b24 5089Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5090is the default setting.
5091
5092@item set print union off
5093Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5094
5095@kindex show print union
5096@item show print union
5097Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5098structures.
5099
5100For example, given the declarations
5101
5102@smallexample
5103typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5104typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5105typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5106 Bug_forms;
5107
5108struct thing @{
5109 Species it;
5110 union @{
5111 Tree_forms tree;
5112 Bug_forms bug;
5113 @} form;
5114@};
5115
5116struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5117@end smallexample
5118
5119@noindent
5120with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5121
5122@smallexample
5123$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5124@end smallexample
5125
5126@noindent
5127and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5128
5129@smallexample
5130$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5131@end smallexample
5132@end table
5133
c906108c
SS
5134@need 1000
5135@noindent
b37052ae 5136These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5137
5138@table @code
5139@cindex demangling
5140@kindex set print demangle
5141@item set print demangle
5142@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5143Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5144(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5145linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5146
5147@kindex show print demangle
5148@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5149Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5150
5151@kindex set print asm-demangle
5152@item set print asm-demangle
5153@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5154Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5155in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5156The default is off.
5157
5158@kindex show print asm-demangle
5159@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5160Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5161or demangled form.
5162
5163@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5164@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5165@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5166@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5167Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5168represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5169
5170@table @code
5171@item auto
5172Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5173
5174@item gnu
b37052ae 5175Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5176This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5177
5178@item hp
b37052ae 5179Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5180
5181@item lucid
b37052ae 5182Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5183
5184@item arm
b37052ae 5185Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5186@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5187debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5188require further enhancement to permit that.
5189
5190@end table
5191If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5192
5193@kindex show demangle-style
5194@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5195Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5196
5197@kindex set print object
5198@item set print object
5199@itemx set print object on
5200When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5201(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5202the virtual function table.
5203
5204@item set print object off
5205Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5206virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5207
5208@kindex show print object
5209@item show print object
5210Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5211
5212@kindex set print static-members
5213@item set print static-members
5214@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5215Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5216
5217@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5218Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5219
5220@kindex show print static-members
5221@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5222Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5223
5224@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5225@kindex set print vtbl
5226@item set print vtbl
5227@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5228Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5229(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5230ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5231
5232@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5233Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5234
5235@kindex show print vtbl
5236@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5237Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5238@end table
c906108c 5239
6d2ebf8b 5240@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5241@section Value history
5242
5243@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5244Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5245@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5246Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5247(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5248When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5249since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5250symbol table.
5251
5252@cindex @code{$}
5253@cindex @code{$$}
5254@cindex history number
5255The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5256refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5257@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5258printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5259history number.
5260
5261To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5262history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5263remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5264the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5265@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5266is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5267@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5268
5269For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5270want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5271
5272@example
5273p *$
5274@end example
5275
5276If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5277to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5278
5279@example
5280p *$.next
5281@end example
5282
5283@noindent
5284You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5285command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5286
5287Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5288@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5289
5290@example
5291print x
5292set x=5
5293@end example
5294
5295@noindent
5296then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5297remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5298
5299@table @code
5300@kindex show values
5301@item show values
5302Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5303This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5304values} does not change the history.
5305
5306@item show values @var{n}
5307Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5308
5309@item show values +
5310Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5311values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5312@end table
5313
5314Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5315same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5316
6d2ebf8b 5317@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5318@section Convenience variables
5319
5320@cindex convenience variables
5321@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5322@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5323exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5324setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5325of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5326
5327Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5328@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5329the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5330(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5331by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5332
5333You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5334expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5335For example:
5336
5337@example
5338set $foo = *object_ptr
5339@end example
5340
5341@noindent
5342would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5343@code{object_ptr}.
5344
5345Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5346value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5347value with another assignment at any time.
5348
5349Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5350variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5351that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5352variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5353
5354@table @code
5355@kindex show convenience
5356@item show convenience
5357Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5358Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5359@end table
5360
5361One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5362incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5363a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5364
5365@example
5366set $i = 0
5367print bar[$i++]->contents
5368@end example
5369
d4f3574e
SS
5370@noindent
5371Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5372
5373Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5374values likely to be useful.
5375
5376@table @code
41afff9a 5377@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5378@item $_
5379The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5380the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5381commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5382set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5383and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5384except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5385to the type of @code{$__}.
5386
41afff9a 5387@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5388@item $__
5389The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5390to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5391to match the format in which the data was printed.
5392
5393@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5394@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5395The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5396the program being debugged terminates.
5397@end table
5398
53a5351d
JM
5399On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5400begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5401name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5402
6d2ebf8b 5403@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5404@section Registers
5405
5406@cindex registers
5407You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5408with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5409for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5410your machine.
5411
5412@table @code
5413@kindex info registers
5414@item info registers
5415Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5416registers (in the selected stack frame).
5417
5418@kindex info all-registers
5419@cindex floating point registers
5420@item info all-registers
5421Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5422registers.
5423
5424@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5425Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5426As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5427the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5428the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5429@end table
5430
5431@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5432expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5433architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5434@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5435the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5436pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5437register that contains the processor status. For example,
5438you could print the program counter in hex with
5439
5440@example
5441p/x $pc
5442@end example
5443
5444@noindent
5445or print the instruction to be executed next with
5446
5447@example
5448x/i $pc
5449@end example
5450
5451@noindent
5452or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5453one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5454memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5455stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5456stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5457regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5458see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5459
5460@example
5461set $sp += 4
5462@end example
5463
5464Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5465your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5466so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5467shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5468registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5469can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5470is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5471
5472@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5473integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5474special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5475registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5476to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5477(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5478@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5479
5480Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5481means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5482the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5483sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5484coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5485programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5486cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5487that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5488prints the data in both formats.
5489
5490Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5491(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5492value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5493were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5494true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5495frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5496
5497However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5498code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5499@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5500frame makes no difference.
5501
6d2ebf8b 5502@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5503@section Floating point hardware
5504@cindex floating point
5505
5506Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5507you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5508
5509@table @code
5510@kindex info float
5511@item info float
5512Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5513point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5514floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5515the ARM and x86 machines.
5516@end table
c906108c 5517
29e57380
C
5518@node Memory Region Attributes
5519@section Memory Region Attributes
5520@cindex memory region attributes
5521
5522@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5523required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5524to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5525use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5526
5527Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5528memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5529accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5530been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5531all memory.
5532
5533When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5534to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5535
5536@table @code
5537@kindex mem
5538@item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5539Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5540with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5541
5542@kindex delete mem
5543@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5544Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5545
5546@kindex disable mem
5547@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5548Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5549A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5550It may be enabled again later.
5551
5552@kindex enable mem
5553@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5554Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5555
5556@kindex info mem
5557@item info mem
5558Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5559for each region.
5560
5561@table @emph
5562@item Memory Region Number
5563@item Enabled or Disabled.
5564Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5565Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5566
5567@item Lo Address
5568The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5569
5570@item Hi Address
5571The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5572
5573@item Attributes
5574The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5575@end table
5576@end table
5577
5578
5579@subsection Attributes
5580
5581@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5582The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5583write accesses to a memory region.
5584
5585While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5586memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5587etc. from accessing memory.
5588
5589@table @code
5590@item ro
5591Memory is read only.
5592@item wo
5593Memory is write only.
5594@item rw
5595Memory is read/write (default).
5596@end table
5597
5598@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5599The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5600accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5601require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5602specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5603
5604@table @code
5605@item 8
5606Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5607@item 16
5608Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5609@item 32
5610Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5611@item 64
5612Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5613@end table
5614
5615@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5616@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5617@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5618@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5619@c
5620@c @table @code
5621@c @item hwbreak
5622@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5623@c @item swbreak (default)
5624@c @end table
5625
5626@subsubsection Data Cache
5627The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5628memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5629protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5630does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5631registers.
5632
5633@table @code
5634@item cache
5635Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5636@item nocache (default)
5637Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5638@end table
5639
5640@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5641@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5642@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5643@c
5644@c @table @code
5645@c @item verify
5646@c @item noverify (default)
5647@c @end table
5648
b37052ae
EZ
5649@node Tracepoints
5650@chapter Tracepoints
5651@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5652@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5653
5654@cindex tracepoints
5655In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5656the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5657anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5658depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5659might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5660fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5661to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5662
5663Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5664specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5665arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5666Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5667those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5668expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5669for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5670a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5671in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5672values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5673unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5674
5675The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
5676targets. @xref{Targets}.
5677
5678This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5679
5680@menu
5681* Set Tracepoints::
5682* Analyze Collected Data::
5683* Tracepoint Variables::
5684@end menu
5685
5686@node Set Tracepoints
5687@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5688
5689Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5690tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5691tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5692breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5693one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5694tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5695work on.
5696
5697For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5698of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5699it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5700local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5701commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5702tracepoint was hit.
5703
5704This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5705conditions and actions.
5706
5707@menu
5708* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5709* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5710* Tracepoint Passcounts::
5711* Tracepoint Actions::
5712* Listing Tracepoints::
5713* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5714@end menu
5715
5716@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5717@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5718
5719@table @code
5720@cindex set tracepoint
5721@kindex trace
5722@item trace
5723The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5724Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5725the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5726defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5727debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5728program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5729doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5730cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5731running.
5732
5733Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5734
5735@smallexample
5736(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5737
5738(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5739
5740(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5741
5742(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5743
5744(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5745@end smallexample
5746
5747@noindent
5748You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5749
5750@vindex $tpnum
5751@cindex last tracepoint number
5752@cindex recent tracepoint number
5753@cindex tracepoint number
5754The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5755of the most recently set tracepoint.
5756
5757@kindex delete tracepoint
5758@cindex tracepoint deletion
5759@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5760Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5761default is to delete all tracepoints.
5762
5763Examples:
5764
5765@smallexample
5766(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5767
5768(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5769@end smallexample
5770
5771@noindent
5772You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5773@end table
5774
5775@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5776@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5777
5778@table @code
5779@kindex disable tracepoint
5780@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5781Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5782@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5783the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5784a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5785
5786@kindex enable tracepoint
5787@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5788Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5789tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5790run.
5791@end table
5792
5793@node Tracepoint Passcounts
5794@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5795
5796@table @code
5797@kindex passcount
5798@cindex tracepoint pass count
5799@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5800Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5801automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5802@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5803the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5804@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5805passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5806given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5807user.
5808
5809Examples:
5810
5811@smallexample
5812(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of tracepoint 2
5813
5814(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
5815 // most recently defined tracepoint.
5816(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5817(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5818(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5819(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5820(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5821(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
5822 // executed 3 times OR when bar has
5823 // been executed 2 times
5824 // OR when baz has been executed 1 time.
5825@end smallexample
5826@end table
5827
5828@node Tracepoint Actions
5829@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5830
5831@table @code
5832@kindex actions
5833@cindex tracepoint actions
5834@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5835This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5836tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5837specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5838recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5839@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5840actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5841terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5842far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5843@code{while-stepping}.
5844
5845@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5846To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5847and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5848
5849@smallexample
5850(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5851
5852(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times and collect data
5853
5854(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
5855@end smallexample
5856
5857In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5858commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5859hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5860following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5861followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5862@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5863@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5864@code{end} command.
5865
5866@smallexample
5867(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5868(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5869Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
5870> collect bar,baz
5871> collect $regs
5872> while-stepping 12
5873 > collect $fp, $sp
5874 > end
5875end
5876@end smallexample
5877
5878@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
5879@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
5880Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
5881This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
5882In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
5883special arguments are supported:
5884
5885@table @code
5886@item $regs
5887collect all registers
5888
5889@item $args
5890collect all function arguments
5891
5892@item $locals
5893collect all local variables.
5894@end table
5895
5896You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
5897with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
5898arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
5899
f5c37c66
EZ
5900The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
5901particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
5902
b37052ae
EZ
5903@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
5904@item while-stepping @var{n}
5905Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
5906new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
5907followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
5908its own @code{end} command):
5909
5910@smallexample
5911> while-stepping 12
5912 > collect $regs, myglobal
5913 > end
5914>
5915@end smallexample
5916
5917@noindent
5918You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
5919@code{stepping}.
5920@end table
5921
5922@node Listing Tracepoints
5923@subsection Listing Tracepoints
5924
5925@table @code
5926@kindex info tracepoints
5927@cindex information about tracepoints
5928@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5929Display information the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify a
5930tracepoint number displays information about all the tracepoints
5931defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
5932shown:
5933
5934@itemize @bullet
5935@item
5936its number
5937@item
5938whether it is enabled or disabled
5939@item
5940its address
5941@item
5942its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
5943@item
5944its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
5945@item
5946where in the source files is the tracepoint set
5947@item
5948its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
5949@end itemize
5950
5951@smallexample
5952(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
5953Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
59541 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
59552 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in gdb_test at gdb_test.c:375
59563 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in collect_data at ../foo.c:1741
5957(@value{GDBP})
5958@end smallexample
5959
5960@noindent
5961This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
5962@end table
5963
5964@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5965@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5966
5967@table @code
5968@kindex tstart
5969@cindex start a new trace experiment
5970@cindex collected data discarded
5971@item tstart
5972This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
5973begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
5974the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
5975experiment.
5976
5977@kindex tstop
5978@cindex stop a running trace experiment
5979@item tstop
5980This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
5981stops collecting data.
5982
5983@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
5984automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
5985(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
5986
5987@kindex tstatus
5988@cindex status of trace data collection
5989@cindex trace experiment, status of
5990@item tstatus
5991This command displays the status of the current trace data
5992collection.
5993@end table
5994
5995Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
5996
5997@smallexample
5998(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
5999(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6000Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6001> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6002> while-stepping 11
6003 > collect $regs
6004 > end
6005> end
6006(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6007 [time passes @dots{}]
6008(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6009@end smallexample
6010
6011
6012@node Analyze Collected Data
6013@section Using the collected data
6014
6015After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6016for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6017collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6018snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6019consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6020examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6021specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6022snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6023registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6024rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6025debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6026(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6027behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6028when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6029the buffer will fail.
6030
6031@menu
6032* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6033* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6034* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6035@end menu
6036
6037@node tfind
6038@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6039
6040@kindex tfind
6041@cindex select trace snapshot
6042@cindex find trace snapshot
6043The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6044@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6045counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6046snapshot is selected.
6047
6048Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6049
6050@table @code
6051@item tfind start
6052Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6053@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6054
6055@item tfind none
6056Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6057
6058@item tfind end
6059Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6060
6061@item tfind
6062No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6063
6064@item tfind -
6065Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6066retracing earlier steps.
6067
6068@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6069Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6070proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6071argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6072for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6073
6074@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6075Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6076program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6077snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6078snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6079
6080@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6081Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6082addresses.
6083
6084@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6085Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6086@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6087
6088@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6089Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6090the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6091that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6092trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6093next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6094@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6095stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6096@end table
6097
6098The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6099designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6100instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6101snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6102trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6103simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6104snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6105@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6106The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6107for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6108no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6109(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6110no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6111tracepoint as the current one.
6112
6113In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6114these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6115scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6116you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6117registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6118
6119@smallexample
6120(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6121(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6122> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6123 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6124> tfind
6125> end
6126
6127Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6128Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6129Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6130Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6131Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6132Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6133Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6134Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6135Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6136Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6137Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6138@end smallexample
6139
6140Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6141the buffer:
6142
6143@smallexample
6144(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6145(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6146> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6147> tfind line
6148> end
6149
6150Frame 0, X = 1
6151Frame 7, X = 2
6152Frame 13, X = 255
6153@end smallexample
6154
6155@node tdump
6156@subsection @code{tdump}
6157@kindex tdump
6158@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6159@cindex tracepoint data, display
6160
6161This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6162the current trace snapshot.
6163
6164@smallexample
6165(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6166(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6167Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6168> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6169> end
6170
6171(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6172
6173(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6174#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6175at gdb_test.c:444
6176444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6177
6178(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6179Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6180d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6181d1 0x18 24
6182d2 0x80 128
6183d3 0x33 51
6184d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6185d5 0x22 34
6186d6 0xe0 224
6187d7 0x380035 3670069
6188a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6189a1 0x3000668 50333288
6190a2 0x100 256
6191a3 0x322000 3284992
6192a4 0x3000698 50333336
6193a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6194fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6195sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6196ps 0x0 0
6197pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6198fpcontrol 0x0 0
6199fpstatus 0x0 0
6200fpiaddr 0x0 0
6201p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6202p1 = (void *) 0x11
6203p2 = (void *) 0x22
6204p3 = (void *) 0x33
6205p4 = (void *) 0x44
6206p5 = (void *) 0x55
6207p6 = (void *) 0x66
6208gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6209
6210(@value{GDBP})
6211@end smallexample
6212
6213@node save-tracepoints
6214@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6215@kindex save-tracepoints
6216@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6217
6218This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6219their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6220suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6221tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6222Files}).
6223
6224@node Tracepoint Variables
6225@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6226@cindex tracepoint variables
6227@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6228
6229@table @code
6230@vindex $trace_frame
6231@item (int) $trace_frame
6232The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6233snapshot is selected.
6234
6235@vindex $tracepoint
6236@item (int) $tracepoint
6237The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6238
6239@vindex $trace_line
6240@item (int) $trace_line
6241The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6242
6243@vindex $trace_file
6244@item (char []) $trace_file
6245The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6246
6247@vindex $trace_func
6248@item (char []) $trace_func
6249The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6250@end table
6251
6252Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6253use @code{output} instead.
6254
6255Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6256stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6257data.
6258
6259@smallexample
6260(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6261
6262(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6263> output $trace_file
6264> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6265> tfind
6266> end
6267@end smallexample
6268
6d2ebf8b 6269@node Languages
c906108c
SS
6270@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6271@cindex languages
6272
c906108c
SS
6273Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6274rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6275dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6276Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 6277represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 6278@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
6279
6280@cindex working language
6281Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6282allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6283native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6284consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6285language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6286language}.
6287
6288@menu
6289* Setting:: Switching between source languages
6290* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 6291* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
6292* Support:: Supported languages
6293@end menu
6294
6d2ebf8b 6295@node Setting
c906108c
SS
6296@section Switching between source languages
6297
6298There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6299set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6300@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6301defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6302used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6303are printed, etc.
6304
6305In addition to the working language, every source file that
6306@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6307file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6308source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6309language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 6310controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 6311show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
6312set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6313set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6314Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
6315
6316This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 6317as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
6318another language. In that case, make the
6319program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6320@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6321program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6322
6323@menu
6324* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6325* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6326* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6327@end menu
6328
6d2ebf8b 6329@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
6330@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6331
6332If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6333@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6334
6335@table @file
6336
6337@item .c
6338C source file
6339
6340@item .C
6341@itemx .cc
6342@itemx .cp
6343@itemx .cpp
6344@itemx .cxx
6345@itemx .c++
b37052ae 6346C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
6347
6348@item .f
6349@itemx .F
6350Fortran source file
6351
c906108c
SS
6352@item .ch
6353@itemx .c186
6354@itemx .c286
96a2c332 6355CHILL source file
c906108c 6356
c906108c
SS
6357@item .mod
6358Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
6359
6360@item .s
6361@itemx .S
6362Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6363@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6364@end table
6365
6366In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6367extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6368
6d2ebf8b 6369@node Manually
c906108c
SS
6370@subsection Setting the working language
6371
6372If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6373expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6374your program.
6375
6376@kindex set language
6377If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6378command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 6379a language, such as
c906108c 6380@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
6381For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6382
c906108c
SS
6383Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6384language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6385to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6386source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6387languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6388source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6389command such as:
6390
6391@example
6392print a = b + c
6393@end example
6394
6395@noindent
6396might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6397@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6398printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6399@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 6400
6d2ebf8b 6401@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
6402@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6403
6404To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6405@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6406then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6407frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6408working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6409frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6410or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6411does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6412not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6413
6414This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6415entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6416written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6417a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6418case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6419
6d2ebf8b 6420@node Show
c906108c 6421@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
6422
6423The following commands help you find out which language is the
6424working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6425
6426@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
6427@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6428@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
6429@table @code
6430@item show language
6431Display the current working language. This is the
6432language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6433build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6434
6435@item info frame
5d161b24 6436Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 6437working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 6438@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6439information listed here.
6440
6441@item info source
6442Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 6443@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6444information listed here.
6445@end table
6446
6447In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6448not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6449with a language explicitly:
6450
6451@kindex set extension-language
6452@kindex info extensions
6453@table @code
6454@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6455Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6456the source language @var{language}.
6457
6458@item info extensions
6459List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6460@end table
6461
6d2ebf8b 6462@node Checks
c906108c
SS
6463@section Type and range checking
6464
6465@quotation
6466@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6467checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6468section documents the intended facilities.
6469@end quotation
6470@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6471
6472Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6473errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6474checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
6475sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
6476these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
6477by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
6478errors when your program is running.
6479
6480@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
6481Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
6482can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
6483the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
6484@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
6485your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
6486for the default settings of supported languages.
6487
6488@menu
6489* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
6490* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
6491@end menu
6492
6493@cindex type checking
6494@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 6495@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
6496@subsection An overview of type checking
6497
6498Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
6499arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
6500otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
6501errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
6502
6503@smallexample
65041 + 2 @result{} 3
6505@exdent but
6506@error{} 1 + 2.3
6507@end smallexample
6508
6509The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
6510type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
6511
5d161b24
DB
6512For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
6513@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
6514to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
6515or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
6516but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
6517these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
6518also issues a warning.
6519
5d161b24
DB
6520Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
6521related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
6522For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
6523a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
6524with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
6525the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
6526
6527Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
6528instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
6529operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
6530represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
6531operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
6532details on specific languages.
6533
6534@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
6535
d4f3574e 6536@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
6537@kindex set check type
6538@kindex show check type
6539@table @code
6540@item set check type auto
6541Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
6542@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6543each language.
6544
6545@item set check type on
6546@itemx set check type off
6547Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6548current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
6549match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 6550evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
6551message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
6552
6553@item set check type warn
6554Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
6555evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
6556be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
6557numbers and structures.
6558
6559@item show type
5d161b24 6560Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6561is setting it automatically.
6562@end table
6563
6564@cindex range checking
6565@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 6566@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
6567@subsection An overview of range checking
6568
6569In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
6570bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
6571checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
6572computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
6573not exceed the bounds of the array.
6574
6575For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
6576@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
6577always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
6578warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
6579
6580A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
6581array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
6582of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
6583error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
6584result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
6585the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
6586
6587@example
6588@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
6589@end example
6590
6591This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
6592specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
6593Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
6594
6595@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
6596
d4f3574e 6597@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
6598@kindex set check range
6599@kindex show check range
6600@table @code
6601@item set check range auto
6602Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
6603@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6604each language.
6605
6606@item set check range on
6607@itemx set check range off
6608Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6609current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
6610match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
6611then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
6612
6613@item set check range warn
6614Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
6615but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
6616expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
6617memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
6618systems).
6619
6620@item show range
6621Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
6622being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
6623@end table
c906108c 6624
6d2ebf8b 6625@node Support
c906108c 6626@section Supported languages
c906108c 6627
b37052ae 6628@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 6629@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
6630Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
6631language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
6632and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
6633,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
6634language.
6635
6636The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
6637supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
6638tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
6639@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
6640formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
6641books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
6642language reference or tutorial.
6643
c906108c 6644@menu
b37052ae 6645* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 6646* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 6647* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
6648@end menu
6649
6d2ebf8b 6650@node C
b37052ae 6651@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 6652
b37052ae
EZ
6653@cindex C and C@t{++}
6654@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 6655
b37052ae 6656Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
6657to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
6658together.
6659
41afff9a
EZ
6660@cindex C@t{++}
6661@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
6662@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
6663The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
6664compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
6665effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
6666C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6667compiler (@code{aCC}).
6668
b37052ae 6669For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
6670format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
6671command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
6672@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
6673CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 6674
c906108c 6675@menu
b37052ae
EZ
6676* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
6677* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
6678* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
6679* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
6680* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 6681* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 6682* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 6683@end menu
c906108c 6684
6d2ebf8b 6685@node C Operators
b37052ae 6686@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 6687
b37052ae 6688@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
6689
6690Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6691@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 6692often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 6693
b37052ae 6694For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
6695
6696@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 6697
c906108c 6698@item
c906108c 6699@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 6700specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
6701
6702@item
d4f3574e
SS
6703@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
6704@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
6705
6706@item
53a5351d 6707@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
6708
6709@item
6710@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 6711
c906108c
SS
6712@end itemize
6713
6714@noindent
6715The following operators are supported. They are listed here
6716in order of increasing precedence:
6717
6718@table @code
6719@item ,
6720The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
6721are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
6722expression being the last expression evaluated.
6723
6724@item =
6725Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
6726assigned. Defined on scalar types.
6727
6728@item @var{op}=
6729Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
6730and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 6731@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
6732@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
6733@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
6734
6735@item ?:
6736The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
6737of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
6738integral type.
6739
6740@item ||
6741Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6742
6743@item &&
6744Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6745
6746@item |
6747Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6748
6749@item ^
6750Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6751
6752@item &
6753Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6754
6755@item ==@r{, }!=
6756Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
6757expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
6758
6759@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
6760Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
6761Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6762and non-zero for true.
6763
6764@item <<@r{, }>>
6765left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6766
6767@item @@
6768The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6769
6770@item +@r{, }-
6771Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6772pointer types.
6773
6774@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6775Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6776defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6777integral types.
6778
6779@item ++@r{, }--
6780Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6781operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6782when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6783operation takes place.
6784
6785@item *
6786Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6787@code{++}.
6788
6789@item &
6790Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6791
b37052ae
EZ
6792For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6793allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 6794(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 6795where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 6796stored.
c906108c
SS
6797
6798@item -
6799Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6800precedence as @code{++}.
6801
6802@item !
6803Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6804@code{++}.
6805
6806@item ~
6807Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6808@code{++}.
6809
6810
6811@item .@r{, }->
6812Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6813@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6814pointer based on the stored type information.
6815Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6816
c906108c
SS
6817@item .*@r{, }->*
6818Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
6819
6820@item []
6821Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6822@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6823
6824@item ()
6825Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6826
c906108c 6827@item ::
b37052ae 6828C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 6829and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
6830
6831@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6832Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6833(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6834above.
c906108c
SS
6835@end table
6836
c906108c
SS
6837If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6838attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6839predefined meaning.
c906108c 6840
c906108c 6841@menu
5d161b24 6842* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
6843@end menu
6844
6d2ebf8b 6845@node C Constants
b37052ae 6846@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6847
b37052ae 6848@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6849
b37052ae 6850@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 6851following ways:
c906108c
SS
6852
6853@itemize @bullet
6854@item
6855Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6856specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6857a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6858@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6859@code{long} value.
6860
6861@item
6862Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6863point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6864exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6865@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6866sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
6867A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6868@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6869the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6870a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6871constant.
c906108c
SS
6872
6873@item
6874Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6875integral equivalents.
6876
6877@item
6878Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6879(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6880(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6881be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6882the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6883of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6884@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6885@samp{\n} for newline.
6886
6887@item
96a2c332
SS
6888String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6889double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6890above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6891a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6892characters.
c906108c
SS
6893
6894@item
6895Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6896to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6897
6898@item
6899Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6900and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6901integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6902and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6903@end itemize
6904
c906108c 6905@menu
5d161b24
DB
6906* C plus plus expressions::
6907* C Defaults::
6908* C Checks::
c906108c 6909
5d161b24 6910* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
6911@end menu
6912
6d2ebf8b 6913@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
6914@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
6915
6916@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
6917@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
6918
6919@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
6920@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
6921@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
6922@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
6923@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
6924@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
6925@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
6926@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
6927@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6928@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6929@c periodically whether this has happened...
6930@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
6931@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
6932proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
6933additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6934special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6935@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6936symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6937you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6938extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 6939@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6940support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6941@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6942
6943@enumerate
6944
6945@cindex member functions
6946@item
6947Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6948
6949@example
6950count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6951@end example
6952
41afff9a 6953@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 6954@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6955@item
6956While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6957expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6958that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 6959pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 6960
c906108c 6961@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6962@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 6963@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6964@item
6965You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6966call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6967perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6968calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6969in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6970default arguments.
6971
6972It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6973promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6974class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6975functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6976number of function arguments.
6977
6978Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6979@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 6980,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 6981
d4f3574e 6982You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6983explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6984@smallexample
6985p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6986@end smallexample
d4f3574e 6987
c906108c 6988The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 6989see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 6990
c906108c
SS
6991@cindex reference declarations
6992@item
b37052ae
EZ
6993@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
6994them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
6995dereferenced.
6996
6997In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6998reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6999avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7000The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7001you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7002
7003@item
b37052ae 7004@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
7005expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7006one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7007necessary, for example in an expression like
7008@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 7009resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7010debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7011@end enumerate
7012
b37052ae 7013In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
7014calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7015objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7016invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 7017
6d2ebf8b 7018@node C Defaults
b37052ae 7019@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 7020
b37052ae 7021@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 7022
c906108c
SS
7023If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7024both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 7025C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 7026selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
7027
7028If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7029recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7030@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 7031these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
7032@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7033for further details.
7034
c906108c
SS
7035@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7036@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7037@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 7038
6d2ebf8b 7039@node C Checks
b37052ae 7040@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 7041
b37052ae 7042@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 7043
b37052ae 7044By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
7045is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7046considers two variables type equivalent if:
7047
7048@itemize @bullet
7049@item
7050The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7051enumerated tag.
7052
7053@item
7054The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7055declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7056
7057@ignore
7058@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7059@c FIXME--beers?
7060@item
7061The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7062declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7063compilers.)
7064@end ignore
7065@end itemize
7066
7067Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7068indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7069that is not itself an array.
c906108c 7070
6d2ebf8b 7071@node Debugging C
c906108c 7072@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
7073
7074The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7075the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
7076inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7077appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
7078
7079The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7080with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7081,Expressions}.
7082
c906108c 7083@menu
5d161b24 7084* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
7085@end menu
7086
6d2ebf8b 7087@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 7088@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7089
b37052ae 7090@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7091
b37052ae
EZ
7092Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7093designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
7094
7095@table @code
7096@cindex break in overloaded functions
7097@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7098When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7099@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7100you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7101
b37052ae 7102@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7103@item rbreak @var{regex}
7104Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7105breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7106classes.
7107@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7108
b37052ae 7109@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
7110@item catch throw
7111@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 7112Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
7113Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7114
7115@cindex inheritance
7116@item ptype @var{typename}
7117Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7118@var{typename}.
7119@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7120
b37052ae 7121@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
7122@item set print demangle
7123@itemx show print demangle
7124@itemx set print asm-demangle
7125@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
7126Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7127displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
7128@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7129
7130@item set print object
7131@itemx show print object
7132Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7133@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7134
7135@item set print vtbl
7136@itemx show print vtbl
7137Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7138@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 7139(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 7140ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
7141
7142@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 7143@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 7144@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 7145Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
7146is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7147and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 7148using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 7149expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
7150message.
7151
7152@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 7153Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
7154overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7155chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7156symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7157overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7158searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7159argument types.
c906108c
SS
7160
7161@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7162You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 7163the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
7164@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7165also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7166available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7167@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7168@end table
c906108c 7169
6d2ebf8b 7170@node Modula-2
c906108c 7171@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 7172
d4f3574e 7173@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
7174
7175The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7176output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7177developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7178attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7179to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7180table.
7181
7182@cindex expressions in Modula-2
7183@menu
7184* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7185* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7186* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7187* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7188* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7189* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7190* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7191* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7192@end menu
7193
6d2ebf8b 7194@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
7195@subsubsection Operators
7196@cindex Modula-2 operators
7197
7198Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7199@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7200often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7201following definitions hold:
7202
7203@itemize @bullet
7204
7205@item
7206@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7207their subranges.
7208
7209@item
7210@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7211
7212@item
7213@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7214
7215@item
7216@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7217@var{type}}.
7218
7219@item
7220@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7221
7222@item
7223@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7224
7225@item
7226@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7227@end itemize
7228
7229@noindent
7230The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7231increasing precedence:
7232
7233@table @code
7234@item ,
7235Function argument or array index separator.
7236
7237@item :=
7238Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7239@var{value}.
7240
7241@item <@r{, }>
7242Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7243types.
7244
7245@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 7246Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
7247on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7248set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7249
7250@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7251Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7252Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7253available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7254comment character.
7255
7256@item IN
7257Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7258Same precedence as @code{<}.
7259
7260@item OR
7261Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7262
7263@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 7264Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
7265
7266@item @@
7267The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7268
7269@item +@r{, }-
7270Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7271and difference on set types.
7272
7273@item *
7274Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7275on set types.
7276
7277@item /
7278Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7279types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7280
7281@item DIV@r{, }MOD
7282Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7283precedence as @code{*}.
7284
7285@item -
7286Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7287
7288@item ^
7289Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7290
7291@item NOT
7292Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7293@code{^}.
7294
7295@item .
7296@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7297precedence as @code{^}.
7298
7299@item []
7300Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7301
7302@item ()
7303Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7304as @code{^}.
7305
7306@item ::@r{, }.
7307@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7308@end table
7309
7310@quotation
7311@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7312treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7313@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7314@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7315@end quotation
7316
7317@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
6d2ebf8b 7318@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c
SS
7319@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
7320
7321Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7322In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7323
7324@table @var
7325
7326@item a
7327represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7328
7329@item c
7330represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7331
7332@item i
7333represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7334
7335@item m
7336represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7337same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7338be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7339
7340@item n
7341represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7342
7343@item r
7344represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7345
7346@item t
7347represents a type.
7348
7349@item v
7350represents a variable.
7351
7352@item x
7353represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7354explanation of the function for details.
7355@end table
7356
7357All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7358
7359@table @code
7360@item ABS(@var{n})
7361Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7362
7363@item CAP(@var{c})
7364If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 7365equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
7366
7367@item CHR(@var{i})
7368Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7369
7370@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7371Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7372
7373@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7374Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7375new value.
7376
7377@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7378Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7379set.
7380
7381@item FLOAT(@var{i})
7382Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7383
7384@item HIGH(@var{a})
7385Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7386
7387@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7388Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7389
7390@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7391Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7392new value.
7393
7394@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7395Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7396there. Returns the new set.
7397
7398@item MAX(@var{t})
7399Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7400
7401@item MIN(@var{t})
7402Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7403
7404@item ODD(@var{i})
7405Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7406
7407@item ORD(@var{x})
7408Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
7409value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7410@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
7411integral, character and enumerated types.
7412
7413@item SIZE(@var{x})
7414Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7415
7416@item TRUNC(@var{r})
7417Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7418
7419@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7420Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7421@end table
7422
7423@quotation
7424@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7425@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7426an error.
7427@end quotation
7428
7429@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 7430@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
7431@subsubsection Constants
7432
7433@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7434ways:
7435
7436@itemize @bullet
7437
7438@item
7439Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7440expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7441rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7442trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7443
7444@item
7445Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7446decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7447then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7448@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7449digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7450digits.
7451
7452@item
7453Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7454like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 7455also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
7456followed by a @samp{C}.
7457
7458@item
7459String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7460pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7461Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 7462Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
7463sequences.
7464
7465@item
7466Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7467
7468@item
7469Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7470@code{FALSE}.
7471
7472@item
7473Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
7474
7475@item
7476Set constants are not yet supported.
7477@end itemize
7478
6d2ebf8b 7479@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
7480@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
7481@cindex Modula-2 defaults
7482
7483If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7484both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7485Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7486selected the working language.
7487
7488If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7489code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 7490working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
7491the language automatically}, for further details.
7492
6d2ebf8b 7493@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
7494@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
7495@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
7496
7497A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
7498This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
7499
7500@itemize @bullet
7501@item
7502Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
7503integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
7504debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
7505pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
7506through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
7507returned a pointer.)
7508
7509@item
7510C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
7511non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
7512escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
7513printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
7514
7515@item
7516The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
7517argument.
7518
7519@item
7520All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
7521@end itemize
7522
6d2ebf8b 7523@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
7524@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
7525@cindex Modula-2 checks
7526
7527@quotation
7528@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
7529range checking.
7530@end quotation
7531@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
7532
7533@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
7534
7535@itemize @bullet
7536@item
7537They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
7538@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
7539
7540@item
7541They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
7542@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
7543@end itemize
7544
7545As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
7546whose types are not equivalent is an error.
7547
7548Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7549index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
7550
6d2ebf8b 7551@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
7552@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7553@cindex scope
41afff9a 7554@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
7555@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
7556@ifinfo
41afff9a 7557@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7558@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
7559@end ifinfo
7560@iftex
41afff9a 7561@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7562@end iftex
7563
7564There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
7565(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
7566similar syntax:
7567
7568@example
7569
7570@var{module} . @var{id}
7571@var{scope} :: @var{id}
7572@end example
7573
7574@noindent
7575where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
7576@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
7577identifier within your program, except another module.
7578
7579Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
7580specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
7581found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
7582enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
7583
7584Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
7585the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
7586definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
7587an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
7588module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
7589@var{module}.
7590
6d2ebf8b 7591@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
7592@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7593
7594Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
7595Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 7596specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 7597@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 7598apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
7599analogue in Modula-2.
7600
7601The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 7602with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 7603intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 7604created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 7605address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 7606@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
7607
7608@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
7609In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
7610interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 7611
6d2ebf8b 7612@node Chill
cce74817
JM
7613@subsection Chill
7614
7615The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 7616from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
7617supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
7618likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7619table.
7620
d4f3574e
SS
7621@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
7622@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
7623This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
7624of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
7625
7626@menu
104c1213
JM
7627* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
7628* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 7629* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 7630* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 7631* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
7632@end menu
7633
6d2ebf8b 7634@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
7635@subsubsection How modes are displayed
7636
7637The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 7638with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
7639slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
7640provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
7641
7642@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
7643@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
7644@table @code
7645@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
7646@itemize @bullet
7647@item
7648@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
7649UINT, LONG, ULONG},
7650@item
5d161b24 7651@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 7652@item
5d161b24 7653@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
7654@item
7655@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
7656@smallexample
7657(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7658type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7659@end smallexample
7660If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
7661@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7662@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
7663@smallexample
7664@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
7665@end smallexample
7666where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
7667expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
7668@end itemize
7669
7670@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
7671A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 7672the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
7673@smallexample
7674(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7675type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
7676@end smallexample
7677
7678@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
7679@itemize @bullet
7680@item
d4f3574e 7681@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
7682followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
7683@item
7684@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
7685@end itemize
7686
7687@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
7688The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
7689<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
7690list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
7691the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
7692all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
7693
7694@ignore
7695@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
7696The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 7697type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
7698@end ignore
7699
5d161b24 7700@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7701@itemize @bullet
7702@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7703@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
7704@smallexample
7705@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
7706@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7707where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
7708@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7709@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
7710@smallexample
7711@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
7712@end smallexample
7713where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
7714@end itemize
7715
5d161b24 7716@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7717@itemize @bullet
7718@item
7719@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
7720@item
7721@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
7722@end itemize
7723
7724@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
7725Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
7726
7727@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
7728@itemize @bullet
7729@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7730@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
7731@smallexample
7732@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
7733@end smallexample
7734followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
7735mode
cce74817 7736@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7737@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
7738@smallexample
7739@code{BOOLS(<string
7740length>)}
7741@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7742@end itemize
7743
7744@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
7745The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
7746followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
7747@smallexample
7748(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
7749type = ARRAY (1:42)
7750 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
7751 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7752@end smallexample
7753
5d161b24 7754@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 7755The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
7756list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
7757of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
7758OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
7759of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
7760checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
7761always displays all variant fields.
7762@smallexample
7763(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7764type = STRUCT (
7765 as x,
7766 bs x,
7767 CASE bs OF
7768 (karli):
7769 cs a
7770 (ott):
7771 ds x
7772 ESAC
7773)
7774@end smallexample
7775@end table
7776
6d2ebf8b 7777@node Locations
cce74817
JM
7778@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7779
7780A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7781
7782A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
7783the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7784Chill programs. How values are specified
7785is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7786
7787The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7788display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 7789
cce74817
JM
7790@smallexample
7791set result := EXPR
7792@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
7793
7794@noindent
7795This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 7796is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
7797
7798Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7799value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 7800mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
7801represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7802value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 7803operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 7804
6d2ebf8b
SS
7805Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7806@smallexample
7807@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 7808(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
7809location>}
7810@end smallexample
7811@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7812specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7813the entry point.
cce74817
JM
7814
7815@ignore
7816Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7817fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7818the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
7819implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7820na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7821<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
7822@code{__proc_copy}.
7823
7824Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7825the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7826like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7827mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7828
7829Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 7830...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 7831definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
7832of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7833structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7834braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 7835on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 7836memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 7837all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 7838@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
7839stuff ???)
7840@smallexample
7841(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7842[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7843@end smallexample
7844@end ignore
7845
7846Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7847(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
7848certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7849and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7850
7851A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
7852location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7853name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7854have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7855checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 7856therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 7857
cce74817
JM
7858@smallexample
7859(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7860@end smallexample
7861
6d2ebf8b 7862@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
7863@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7864
7865Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7866more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
7867data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7868such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 7869constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 7870when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
7871(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7872the values behind these locations.
7873
d4f3574e 7874This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
7875operations are legal to be used with such values.
7876
7877@table @code
7878@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
7879Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7880For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 7881chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
7882@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7883@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 7884
5d161b24 7885@ignore
cce74817
JM
7886@itemize @bullet
7887@item
7888@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 7889programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7890@item
7891@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7892@item
7893@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7894@code{'M'})
7895@item
7896@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e 7897mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
b37052ae 7898comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
cce74817 7899@item
d4f3574e 7900@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 7901emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 7902procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
7903
7904@item
7905@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7906enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7907to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7908@item
7909@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7910programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7911@item
7912@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7913(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7914@end itemize
7915@end ignore
7916
7917@item Tuple Values
7918A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7919name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7920unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7921@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7922
cce74817
JM
7923@itemize @bullet
7924@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7925@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7926@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7927Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7928same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7929@end itemize
7930
7931@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
7932A string element value is specified by
7933@smallexample
7934@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7935@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7936where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7937value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7938the string.
7939
7940@item String Slice Value
7941A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7942spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7943expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7944@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7945The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7946string.
7947
7948@item Array Element Values
7949An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7950delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7951
7952@item Array Slice Values
7953An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7954@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7955@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7956arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7957which is part of the specified array.
7958
7959@item Structure Field Values
7960A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7961name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7962in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7963corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7964
7965@item Procedure Call Value
7966The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7967procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7968expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7969effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 7970
d4f3574e 7971Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 7972
6d2ebf8b
SS
7973Values of time mode locations appear as
7974@smallexample
7975@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7976@end smallexample
7977
cce74817
JM
7978
7979@ignore
7980This is not implemented yet:
7981@item Built-in Value
7982@noindent
7983The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 7984
cce74817
JM
7985@table @code
7986@item @code{ADDR()}
7987@item @code{NUM()}
7988@item @code{PRED()}
7989@item @code{SUCC()}
7990@item @code{ABS()}
7991@item @code{CARD()}
7992@item @code{MAX()}
7993@item @code{MIN()}
7994@item @code{SIZE()}
7995@item @code{UPPER()}
7996@item @code{LOWER()}
7997@item @code{LENGTH()}
7998@item @code{SIN()}
7999@item @code{COS()}
8000@item @code{TAN()}
8001@item @code{ARCSIN()}
8002@item @code{ARCCOS()}
8003@item @code{ARCTAN()}
8004@item @code{EXP()}
8005@item @code{LN()}
8006@item @code{LOG()}
8007@item @code{SQRT()}
8008@end table
8009
8010For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8011chapter 1.6.
8012@end ignore
8013
8014@item Zero-adic Operator Value
8015The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8016current active process.
8017
8018@item Expression Values
8019The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 8020the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 8021incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 8022corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 8023causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 8024which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 8025operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 8026
cce74817
JM
8027@table @code
8028@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8029@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8030@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8031Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 8032
cce74817
JM
8033@item @code{=, /=}
8034Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 8035
cce74817 8036@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8037@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8038Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8039
cce74817 8040@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 8041@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 8042Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8043
cce74817
JM
8044@item @code{-}
8045Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 8046
cce74817
JM
8047@item @code{//}
8048String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 8049
cce74817
JM
8050@item @code{()}
8051String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 8052
cce74817
JM
8053@item @code{->}
8054Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8055address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8056location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 8057
cce74817 8058@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8059@itemx @code{AND}
8060@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8061Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 8062
cce74817 8063@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8064@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8065Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 8066
cce74817
JM
8067@item @code{IN}
8068Membership operator.
8069@end table
8070@end table
8071
6d2ebf8b 8072@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
8073@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8074
8075@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 8076of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 8077complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 8078equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
8079structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8080
8081Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8082index bounds and all built in procedures.
8083
8084Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 8085check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
8086operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8087functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8088language specification.
8089
cce74817
JM
8090All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8091off}.
8092
5d161b24 8093@ignore
53a5351d 8094@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
8095see last paragraph ?
8096@end ignore
8097
6d2ebf8b 8098@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
8099@subsubsection Chill defaults
8100
8101If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8102both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8103Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
8104selected the working language.
8105
8106If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8107code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 8108working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
8109the language automatically}, for further details.
8110
6d2ebf8b 8111@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8112@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8113
d4f3574e 8114The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8115symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8116program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8117does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8118program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8119(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8120file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8121
8122@cindex symbol names
8123@cindex names of symbols
8124@cindex quoting names
8125Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8126characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8127most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8128source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8129are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8130ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8131@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8132@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8133
8134@example
8135p 'foo.c'::x
8136@end example
8137
8138@noindent
8139looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8140
8141@table @code
8142@kindex info address
b37052ae 8143@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8144@item info address @var{symbol}
8145Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8146variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8147local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8148is always stored.
8149
8150Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8151at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8152the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8153
3d67e040 8154@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8155@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8156@item info symbol @var{addr}
8157Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8158If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8159nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8160
8161@example
8162(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8163_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8164@end example
8165
8166@noindent
8167This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8168it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8169
c906108c 8170@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8171@item whatis @var{expr}
8172Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8173actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8174assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8175@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8176
8177@item whatis
8178Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8179
8180@kindex ptype
8181@item ptype @var{typename}
8182Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8183the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8184@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8185@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8186
d4f3574e 8187@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8188@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8189Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8190differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8191of just the name of the type.
8192
8193For example, for this variable declaration:
8194
8195@example
8196struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8197@end example
8198
8199@noindent
8200the two commands give this output:
8201
8202@example
8203@group
8204(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8205type = struct complex
8206(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8207type = struct complex @{
8208 double real;
8209 double imag;
8210@}
8211@end group
8212@end example
8213
8214@noindent
8215As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8216the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8217
8218@kindex info types
8219@item info types @var{regexp}
8220@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8221Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8222(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8223complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8224@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8225names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8226information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8227
8228This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8229@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8230lists all source files where a type is defined.
8231
b37052ae
EZ
8232@kindex info scope
8233@cindex local variables
8234@item info scope @var{addr}
8235List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8236accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8237preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8238scope defined by that location. For example:
8239
8240@smallexample
8241(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8242Scope for command_line_handler:
8243Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8244Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8245Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8246Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8247Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8248Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8249Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8250@end smallexample
8251
f5c37c66
EZ
8252@noindent
8253This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8254during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8255collect}.
8256
c906108c
SS
8257@kindex info source
8258@item info source
8259Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8260the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8261it was written in.
8262
8263@kindex info sources
8264@item info sources
8265Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8266debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8267have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8268
8269@kindex info functions
8270@item info functions
8271Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8272
8273@item info functions @var{regexp}
8274Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8275whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8276Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8277include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
8278start with @code{step}.
8279
8280@kindex info variables
8281@item info variables
8282Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8283outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
8284
8285@item info variables @var{regexp}
8286Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8287variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8288@var{regexp}.
8289
8290@ignore
8291This was never implemented.
8292@kindex info methods
8293@item info methods
8294@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8295The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8296methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8297specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8298C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8299from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8300@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8301which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8302@end ignore
8303
c906108c
SS
8304@cindex reloading symbols
8305Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8306be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8307in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8308running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8309@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8310
8311@table @code
8312@kindex set symbol-reloading
8313@item set symbol-reloading on
8314Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8315object file with a particular name is seen again.
8316
8317@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8318Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8319same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8320running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8321should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8322may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8323several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8324name.
c906108c
SS
8325
8326@kindex show symbol-reloading
8327@item show symbol-reloading
8328Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8329@end table
c906108c 8330
c906108c
SS
8331@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8332@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8333Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8334declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8335@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8336source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8337another source file. The default is on.
8338
8339A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8340the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8341
8342@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8343Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8344is printed as follows:
8345@smallexample
8346@{<no data fields>@}
8347@end smallexample
8348
8349@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8350@item show opaque-type-resolution
8351Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8352
8353@kindex maint print symbols
8354@cindex symbol dump
8355@kindex maint print psymbols
8356@cindex partial symbol dump
8357@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8358@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8359@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8360Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8361These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8362symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8363symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8364collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8365only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8366command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8367use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8368symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8369files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8370@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8371required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8372@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8373@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8374@end table
8375
6d2ebf8b 8376@node Altering
c906108c
SS
8377@chapter Altering Execution
8378
8379Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8380find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8381correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8382experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8383program.
8384
8385For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
8386locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8387address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
8388
8389@menu
8390* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8391* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 8392* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
8393* Returning:: Returning from a function
8394* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8395* Patching:: Patching your program
8396@end menu
8397
6d2ebf8b 8398@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
8399@section Assignment to variables
8400
8401@cindex assignment
8402@cindex setting variables
8403To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8404@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8405
8406@example
8407print x=4
8408@end example
8409
8410@noindent
8411stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 8412value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
8413@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8414information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
8415
8416@kindex set variable
8417@cindex variables, setting
8418If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8419@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8420really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8421not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8422,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8423
c906108c
SS
8424If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8425appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8426variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8427to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8428program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8429a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8430command @code{set width}:
8431
8432@example
8433(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8434type = double
8435(@value{GDBP}) p width
8436$4 = 13
8437(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8438Invalid syntax in expression.
8439@end example
8440
8441@noindent
8442The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8443order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8444
8445@example
8446(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8447@end example
53a5351d 8448
c906108c
SS
8449Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8450with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8451@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8452your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8453to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8454the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8455
8456@example
8457@group
8458(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8459type = double
8460(@value{GDBP}) p g
8461$1 = 1
8462(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 8463(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
8464$2 = 1
8465(@value{GDBP}) r
8466The program being debugged has been started already.
8467Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8468Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
8469"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8470 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
8471(@value{GDBP}) show g
8472The current BFD target is "=4".
8473@end group
8474@end example
8475
8476@noindent
8477The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
8478@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
8479@code{g}, use
8480
8481@example
8482(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
8483@end example
c906108c
SS
8484
8485@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
8486freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
8487and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
8488same length or shorter.
8489@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
8490@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
8491
8492To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
8493construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
8494(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
8495to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
8496and representation in memory), and
8497
8498@example
8499set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
8500@end example
8501
8502@noindent
8503stores the value 4 into that memory location.
8504
6d2ebf8b 8505@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
8506@section Continuing at a different address
8507
8508Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
8509it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
8510an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
8511
8512@table @code
8513@kindex jump
8514@item jump @var{linespec}
8515Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
8516immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
8517source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
8518@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
8519in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
8520breakpoints}.
8521
8522The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
8523the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
8524register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
8525a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
8526be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
8527of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
8528confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
8529executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
8530well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
8531
8532@item jump *@var{address}
8533Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
8534@end table
8535
c906108c 8536@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
8537On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
8538command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
8539difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
8540changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
8541example,
c906108c
SS
8542
8543@example
8544set $pc = 0x485
8545@end example
8546
8547@noindent
8548makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
8549address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
8550@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
8551
8552The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
8553up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
8554that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
8555detail.
8556
c906108c 8557@c @group
6d2ebf8b 8558@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
8559@section Giving your program a signal
8560
8561@table @code
8562@kindex signal
8563@item signal @var{signal}
8564Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
8565signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
8566signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
8567SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
8568
8569Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
8570giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
8571a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
8572@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
8573signal.
8574
8575@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
8576after executing the command.
8577@end table
8578@c @end group
8579
8580Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
8581@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
8582causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
8583the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
8584passes the signal directly to your program.
8585
c906108c 8586
6d2ebf8b 8587@node Returning
c906108c
SS
8588@section Returning from a function
8589
8590@table @code
8591@cindex returning from a function
8592@kindex return
8593@item return
8594@itemx return @var{expression}
8595You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
8596command. If you give an
8597@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
8598value.
8599@end table
8600
8601When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
8602(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
8603discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
8604be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
8605
8606This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
8607frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
8608innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
8609specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
8610of functions.
8611
8612The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
8613program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
8614returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
8615and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
8616selected stack frame returns naturally.
8617
6d2ebf8b 8618@node Calling
c906108c
SS
8619@section Calling program functions
8620
8621@cindex calling functions
8622@kindex call
8623@table @code
8624@item call @var{expr}
8625Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
8626returned values.
8627@end table
8628
8629You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
8630execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
8631with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
8632is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 8633
c906108c
SS
8634For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
8635specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
8636calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
8637method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
8638that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 8639
6d2ebf8b 8640@node Patching
c906108c 8641@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 8642
c906108c
SS
8643@cindex patching binaries
8644@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 8645@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 8646
7a292a7a
SS
8647By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
8648executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
8649alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
8650patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
8651
8652If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
8653explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
8654want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
8655repairs.
8656
8657@table @code
8658@kindex set write
8659@item set write on
8660@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
8661If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
8662core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
8663off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
8664
8665If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
8666@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
8667write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
8668
8669@item show write
8670@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
8671Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
8672as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
8673@end table
8674
6d2ebf8b 8675@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
8676@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
8677
7a292a7a
SS
8678@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
8679both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
8680program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
8681@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
8682
8683@menu
8684* Files:: Commands to specify files
8685* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
8686@end menu
8687
6d2ebf8b 8688@node Files
c906108c 8689@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 8690
7a292a7a 8691@cindex symbol table
c906108c 8692@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
8693
8694You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
8695way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
8696@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
8697Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
8698
8699Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
8700@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
8701a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
8702to specify new files are useful.
8703
8704@table @code
8705@cindex executable file
8706@kindex file
8707@item file @var{filename}
8708Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
8709symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
8710executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
8711directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
8712@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
8713directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
8714to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8715and your program, using the @code{path} command.
8716
6d2ebf8b 8717On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
8718@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
8719@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
8720@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
8721descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
8722(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 8723@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 8724for more information.
c906108c
SS
8725
8726@item file
8727@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
8728has on both executable file and the symbol table.
8729
8730@kindex exec-file
8731@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8732Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
8733in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
8734if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
8735discard information on the executable file.
8736
8737@kindex symbol-file
8738@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8739Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
8740searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
8741table and program to run from the same file.
8742
8743@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
8744program's symbol table.
8745
5d161b24 8746The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
8747of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
8748auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
8749the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
8750the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
8751
8752@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
8753executing it once.
8754
8755When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
8756understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
8757generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
8758other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
8759Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
8760using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
8761optimized code.
c906108c
SS
8762
8763For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
8764using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
8765symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
8766quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
8767details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
8768
8769The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
8770start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
8771occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
8772file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
8773pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
8774warnings and messages}.)
8775
c906108c
SS
8776We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
8777symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
8778symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
8779still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
8780in stabs format.
8781
8782@kindex readnow
8783@cindex reading symbols immediately
8784@cindex symbols, reading immediately
8785@kindex mapped
8786@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
8787@cindex saving symbol table
8788@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8789@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8790You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
8791tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
8792load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 8793entire symbol table available.
c906108c 8794
c906108c
SS
8795If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
8796@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
8797cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
8798file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
8799from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
8800than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
8801program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
8802starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
8803
8804You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8805file has all the symbol information for your program.
8806
8807The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8808@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8809than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8810it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8811needed.
8812
8813The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8814@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8815symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
8816
8817@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8818@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8819@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8820@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8821@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8822@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8823@c files.
8824
8825@kindex core
8826@kindex core-file
8827@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8828Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8829of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8830address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8831executable file itself for other parts.
8832
8833@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8834to be used.
8835
8836Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
8837under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8838wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8839the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 8840(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 8841
c906108c
SS
8842@kindex add-symbol-file
8843@cindex dynamic linking
8844@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8845@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
d167840f 8846@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
96a2c332
SS
8847The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8848information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8849when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8850into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8851address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
8852this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8853of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8854section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8855@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
8856
8857The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8858originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
8859@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8860thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8861instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c
SS
8862
8863@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8864
8865You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8866the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8867table information for @var{filename}.
8868
8869@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8870@item add-shared-symbol-file
8871The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
8872operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8873shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 8874@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 8875
c906108c
SS
8876@kindex section
8877@item section
5d161b24
DB
8878The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8879the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8880section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8881specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
8882separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8883the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
8884
8885@kindex info files
8886@kindex info target
8887@item info files
8888@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
8889@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8890current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8891including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8892use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8893command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8894current ones.
8895
c906108c
SS
8896@end table
8897
8898All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8899as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8900name and remembers it that way.
8901
c906108c 8902@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
8903@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8904libraries.
53a5351d 8905
c906108c
SS
8906@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8907when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8908(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8909references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8910debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
8911
8912On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8913automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8914
c906108c
SS
8915@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8916@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8917@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8918
8919@table @code
8920@kindex info sharedlibrary
8921@kindex info share
8922@item info share
8923@itemx info sharedlibrary
8924Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8925
8926@kindex sharedlibrary
8927@kindex share
8928@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8929@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
8930Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8931Unix regular expression.
8932As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8933required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8934@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8935loaded.
8936@end table
8937
53a5351d
JM
8938On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8939and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8940a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
8941
8942Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
8943loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8944@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
8945automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8946
8947To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8948
8949@table @code
8950@kindex set auto-solib-add
8951@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8952Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8953nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8954automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8955linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8956the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8957Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8958@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8959
8960@kindex show auto-solib-add
8961@item show auto-solib-add
8962Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8963@end table
c906108c 8964
6d2ebf8b 8965@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
8966@section Errors reading symbol files
8967
8968While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8969such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8970output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8971they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8972debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8973about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8974only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8975times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8976to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8977complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8978messages}).
8979
8980The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8981
8982@table @code
8983@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8984
8985The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8986(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8987error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8988in its outer scope blocks.
8989
8990@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8991the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
8992may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
8993function.
8994
8995@item block at @var{address} out of order
8996
8997The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
8998order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
8999do so.
9000
9001@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9002locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9003can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9004@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9005messages}.)
9006
9007@item bad block start address patched
9008
9009The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9010smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9011to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9012
9013@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9014starting on the previous source line.
9015
9016@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9017
9018@cindex foo
9019Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9020larger than the size of the string table.
9021
9022@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9023name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9024with this name.
9025
9026@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9027
7a292a7a
SS
9028The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9029not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9030uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9031
7a292a7a
SS
9032@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9033This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9034are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9035debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9036on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9037and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9038
9039@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9040
7a292a7a 9041@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9042
7a292a7a 9043@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9044The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9045information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9046it.
c906108c
SS
9047
9048@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9049
9050@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9051
c906108c
SS
9052@end table
9053
6d2ebf8b 9054@node Targets
c906108c 9055@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9056
c906108c
SS
9057@cindex debugging target
9058@kindex target
9059
9060A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9061
9062Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9063in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9064you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9065flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9066host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9067realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9068command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9069(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9070
9071@menu
9072* Active Targets:: Active targets
9073* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9074* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9075* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9076* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9077
9078@end menu
9079
6d2ebf8b 9080@node Active Targets
c906108c 9081@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9082
c906108c
SS
9083@cindex stacking targets
9084@cindex active targets
9085@cindex multiple targets
9086
c906108c 9087There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9088executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9089active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9090start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9091a core file.
c906108c
SS
9092
9093For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9094@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9095well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9096@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9097first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9098requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9099are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9100read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9101executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9102
9103When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9104target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9105commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9106an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9107process target is active.
c906108c 9108
7a292a7a
SS
9109Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9110core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9111files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9112the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9113process}).
c906108c 9114
6d2ebf8b 9115@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9116@section Commands for managing targets
9117
9118@table @code
9119@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9120Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9121process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9122facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9123protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9124
9125Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9126typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9127with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9128
9129The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9130after executing the command.
9131
9132@kindex help target
9133@item help target
9134Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9135currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9136(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9137
9138@item help target @var{name}
9139Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9140select it.
9141
9142@kindex set gnutarget
9143@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9144@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9145knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9146a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9147with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9148with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9149
d4f3574e 9150@quotation
c906108c
SS
9151@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9152you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9153@end quotation
c906108c 9154
d4f3574e
SS
9155@noindent
9156@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9157
5d161b24 9158@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9159@item show gnutarget
9160Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9161@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9162@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9163and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9164@end table
9165
c906108c
SS
9166Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9167configuration):
c906108c
SS
9168
9169@table @code
9170@kindex target exec
9171@item target exec @var{program}
9172An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9173@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9174
c906108c
SS
9175@kindex target core
9176@item target core @var{filename}
9177A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9178@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9179
9180@kindex target remote
9181@item target remote @var{dev}
9182Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9183specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9184@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9185supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9186some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9187it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9188
c906108c
SS
9189@kindex target sim
9190@item target sim
2df3850c 9191Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
9192In general,
9193@example
9194 target sim
9195 load
9196 run
9197@end example
d4f3574e 9198@noindent
104c1213 9199works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9200drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9201provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9202see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9203Processors}.
9204
c906108c
SS
9205@end table
9206
104c1213 9207Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9208
9209@table @code
9210
c906108c
SS
9211@kindex target nrom
9212@item target nrom @var{dev}
9213NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9214
c906108c
SS
9215@end table
9216
5d161b24 9217Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9218your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9219
9220Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9221once you've successfully established a connection.
9222
9223@table @code
9224
9225@kindex load @var{filename}
9226@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9227Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9228@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9229is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9230on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9231@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9232the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9233
9234If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9235execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9236target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9237
9238The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9239For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9240link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9241specifies a fixed address.
9242@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9243
c906108c
SS
9244@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9245@end table
9246
6d2ebf8b 9247@node Byte Order
c906108c 9248@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 9249
c906108c
SS
9250@cindex choosing target byte order
9251@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
9252
9253Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9254offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9255orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9256designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9257which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 9258@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
9259
9260@table @code
9261@kindex set endian big
9262@item set endian big
9263Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9264
9265@kindex set endian little
9266@item set endian little
9267Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9268
9269@kindex set endian auto
9270@item set endian auto
9271Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9272executable.
9273
9274@item show endian
9275Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9276
9277@end table
9278
9279Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9280data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9281target system.
9282
6d2ebf8b 9283@node Remote
c906108c
SS
9284@section Remote debugging
9285@cindex remote debugging
9286
9287If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
9288@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9289For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
9290or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9291powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9292
9293Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9294to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 9295@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
9296but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9297write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9298communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9299
9300Other remote targets may be available in your
9301configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 9302
c906108c 9303@menu
c906108c 9304* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
9305@end menu
9306
6d2ebf8b 9307@node Remote Serial
104c1213 9308@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 9309
104c1213
JM
9310@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
9311To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
9312@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
9313prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
9314program, you need:
c906108c 9315
104c1213
JM
9316@enumerate
9317@item
9318A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
9319have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
9320your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 9321
5d161b24 9322@item
d4f3574e 9323A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 9324subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 9325
104c1213
JM
9326@item
9327A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
9328download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
9329manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
9330documentation.
9331@end enumerate
96baa820 9332
104c1213
JM
9333The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
9334communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
9335machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 9336
104c1213
JM
9337@table @emph
9338@item On the host,
9339@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
9340else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
9341(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
9342
9343@item On the target,
9344you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
9345implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
9346subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
9347
9348On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
9349@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
9350@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
9351@end table
96baa820 9352
104c1213
JM
9353The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
9354machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
9355@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 9356
104c1213
JM
9357@cindex remote serial stub list
9358These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 9359
104c1213
JM
9360@table @code
9361
9362@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 9363@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9364@cindex Intel
9365@cindex i386
9366For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
9367
9368@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 9369@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9370@cindex Motorola 680x0
9371@cindex m680x0
9372For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
9373
9374@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 9375@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9376@cindex Hitachi
9377@cindex SH
9378For Hitachi SH architectures.
9379
9380@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 9381@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9382@cindex Sparc
9383For @sc{sparc} architectures.
9384
9385@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 9386@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9387@cindex Fujitsu
9388@cindex SparcLite
9389For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
9390
9391@end table
9392
9393The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
9394recently added stubs.
9395
9396@menu
9397* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
9398* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
9399* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
9400* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
9401* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
9402* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
9403@end menu
9404
6d2ebf8b 9405@node Stub Contents
104c1213
JM
9406@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
9407
9408@cindex remote serial stub
9409The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
9410subroutines:
9411
9412@table @code
9413@item set_debug_traps
9414@kindex set_debug_traps
9415@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
9416This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
9417program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
9418beginning of your program.
9419
9420@item handle_exception
9421@kindex handle_exception
9422@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
9423This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
9424explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
9425run when a trap is triggered.
9426
9427@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
9428execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
9429with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
9430protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 9431representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
9432information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
9433retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
9434execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
9435@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 9436machine.
104c1213
JM
9437
9438@item breakpoint
9439@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
9440Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
9441breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
9442way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
9443machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
9444pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
9445@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
9446simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
9447again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
9448your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 9449@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
9450
9451Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
9452to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
9453start of your debugging session.
9454@end table
9455
6d2ebf8b 9456@node Bootstrapping
104c1213
JM
9457@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
9458
9459@cindex remote stub, support routines
9460The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
9461chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
9462debugging target machine.
9463
9464First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
9465serial port.
9466
9467@table @code
9468@item int getDebugChar()
9469@kindex getDebugChar
9470Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
9471It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
9472different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9473
9474@item void putDebugChar(int)
9475@kindex putDebugChar
9476Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 9477It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
9478different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9479@end table
9480
9481@cindex control C, and remote debugging
9482@cindex interrupting remote targets
9483If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
9484running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
9485for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
9486character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
9487remote system to stop.
9488
9489Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
9490probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
9491is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
9492@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
9493
9494Other routines you need to supply are:
9495
9496@table @code
9497@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
9498@kindex exceptionHandler
9499Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
9500handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
9501way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
9502are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
9503containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
9504@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
9505its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
9506might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
9507exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
9508@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
9509and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
9510you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
9511should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
9512
9513For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
9514gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
9515should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
9516@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
9517help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
9518
9519@item void flush_i_cache()
9520@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 9521On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
9522instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
9523instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
9524
9525On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
9526function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
9527@end table
9528
9529@noindent
9530You must also make sure this library routine is available:
9531
9532@table @code
9533@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
9534@kindex memset
9535This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
9536memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
9537@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
9538either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
9539@end table
9540
9541If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
9542library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
9543but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 9544subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
9545
9546
6d2ebf8b 9547@node Debug Session
104c1213
JM
9548@subsubsection Putting it all together
9549
9550@cindex remote serial debugging summary
9551In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
9552steps.
9553
9554@enumerate
9555@item
6d2ebf8b 9556Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
9557(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
9558@display
9559@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
9560@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
9561@end display
9562
9563@item
9564Insert these lines near the top of your program:
9565
9566@example
9567set_debug_traps();
9568breakpoint();
9569@end example
9570
9571@item
9572For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
9573@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
9574
9575@example
9576void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
9577@end example
9578
d4f3574e 9579@noindent
104c1213 9580but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 9581function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
9582@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
9583error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
9584one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
9585
9586@item
9587Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
9588your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
9589
9590@item
9591Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
9592the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
9593
9594@item
9595@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
9596@c document that. FIXME.
9597Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
9598whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
9599
9600@item
9601To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
9602as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
9603This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
9604of its pure text.
9605
d4f3574e 9606@item
104c1213 9607@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9608Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
9609Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
9610machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9611TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
9612to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
9613device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
9614
9615@example
9616target remote /dev/ttyb
9617@end example
9618
9619@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
9620To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9621@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
9622terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
9623
9624@example
9625target remote manyfarms:2828
9626@end example
9627@end enumerate
9628
9629Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
9630step and continue the remote program.
9631
9632To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
9633command.
9634
9635@cindex interrupting remote programs
9636@cindex remote programs, interrupting
9637Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
9638interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
9639program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
9640and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
9641interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
9642
9643@example
9644Interrupted while waiting for the program.
9645Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
9646@end example
9647
9648If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
9649(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
9650remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
9651goes back to waiting.
9652
6d2ebf8b 9653@node Protocol
104c1213
JM
9654@subsubsection Communication protocol
9655
9656@cindex debugging stub, example
9657@cindex remote stub, example
9658@cindex stub example, remote debugging
9659The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
9660communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
9661@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
9662these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
9663implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
9664with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
9665organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
9666
9667However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
9668the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
9669target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
9670it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
9671
9672In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
9673transmitted and received data respectfully.
9674
9675@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
9676@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
9677@cindex remote serial protocol
6cf7e474
AC
9678All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
9679sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
9680@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
9681@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
104c1213
JM
9682
9683@example
9684@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9685@end example
9686@noindent
104c1213
JM
9687
9688@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
9689@noindent
9690The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
6cf7e474
AC
9691characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
9692eight bit unsigned checksum).
9693
9694Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
9695specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
9696
9697@example
9698@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9699@end example
104c1213
JM
9700
9701@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
9702@noindent
6cf7e474
AC
9703That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
9704has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
9705since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
104c1213 9706
6cf7e474 9707@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
104c1213
JM
9708When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
9709response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
9710the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
9711retransmission):
9712
9713@example
9714<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9715-> @code{+}
9716@end example
9717@noindent
104c1213
JM
9718
9719The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
9720debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
9721the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
9722when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
9723
9724@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
6cf7e474
AC
9725exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
9726exceptions).
9727
9728Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
9729@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
9730HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
9731
9732Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
9733@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
9734would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
104c1213
JM
9735
9736Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 9737means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
9738which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
9739@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
9740where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
9741characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
9742value greater than 126 should not be used.
9743
9744Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
9745loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
9746character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
9747
9748So:
9749@example
9750"@code{0* }"
9751@end example
9752@noindent
9753means the same as "0000".
9754
598ca718 9755The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
104c1213
JM
9756error number. That number is not well defined.
9757
9758For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
9759(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
9760protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 9761on that response.
104c1213 9762
f1251bdd
C
9763A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
9764@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
9765optional.
9766
104c1213
JM
9767Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
9768their corresponding response @var{data}:
598ca718 9769@page
104c1213
JM
9770@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
9771@item Packet
9772@tab Request
9773@tab Description
9774
f1251bdd 9775@item extended ops
104c1213
JM
9776@tab @code{!}
9777@tab
d4f3574e 9778Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
598ca718 9779The extended remote protocol supports the @samp{R} packet.
104c1213
JM
9780@item
9781@tab reply @samp{}
9782@tab
9783Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
9784unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
9785support protocol extensions.
9786
9787@item last signal
9788@tab @code{?}
9789@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9790Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
9791and continue.
9792@item
9793@tab reply
9794@tab see below
9795
104c1213
JM
9796
9797@item reserved
9798@tab @code{a}
5d161b24 9799@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9800
f1251bdd 9801@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9802@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
9803@tab
598ca718
EZ
9804@item
9805@tab
9806@tab
104c1213
JM
9807Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9808specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 9809See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
9810@item
9811@tab reply @code{OK}
9812@item
9813@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9814
9815@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9816@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9817@tab
9818Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9819transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9820transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9821acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9822to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9823ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9824specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9825that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9826happened.}
9827
9828@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9829@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9830@tab
9831Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9832breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9833@samp{z} packets.}
9834
9835@item continue
9836@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9837@tab
9838@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9839current address.
9840@item
9841@tab reply
9842@tab see below
9843
f1251bdd 9844@item continue with signal
104c1213
JM
9845@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9846@tab
9847Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9848@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9849@item
9850@tab reply
9851@tab see below
9852
598ca718 9853@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
9854@tab @code{d}
9855@tab
d4f3574e 9856toggle debug flag.
104c1213 9857
f1251bdd 9858@item detach
104c1213 9859@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 9860@tab
2df3850c
JM
9861Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9862@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
9863@item
9864@tab reply @emph{no response}
9865@tab
598ca718 9866@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
104c1213
JM
9867
9868@item reserved
9869@tab @code{e}
5d161b24 9870@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9871
9872@item reserved
9873@tab @code{E}
5d161b24 9874@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9875
9876@item reserved
9877@tab @code{f}
5d161b24 9878@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9879
9880@item reserved
9881@tab @code{F}
5d161b24 9882@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9883
9884@item read registers
9885@tab @code{g}
9886@tab Read general registers.
9887@item
9888@tab reply @var{XX...}
9889@tab
9890Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9891with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 9892each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 9893determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
9894@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9895@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
9896@item
9897@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9898@tab for an error.
9899
9900@item write regs
9901@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9902@tab
9903See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9904@item
9905@tab reply @code{OK}
9906@tab for success
9907@item
9908@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9909@tab for an error
9910
9911@item reserved
9912@tab @code{h}
5d161b24 9913@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9914
f1251bdd 9915@item set thread
104c1213
JM
9916@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9917@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9918Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9919@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9920continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9921thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
9922@item
9923@tab reply @code{OK}
9924@tab for success
9925@item
9926@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9927@tab for an error
9928
d4f3574e
SS
9929@c FIXME: JTC:
9930@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
5d161b24 9931@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
d4f3574e
SS
9932@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9933@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9934@c described. For example:
9935@c
9936@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9937@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9938@c otherwise returns current registers.
9939@c
9940@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9941@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9942@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9943
f1251bdd 9944@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9945@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9946@tab
9947Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9948present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9949step starting at that address.
9950
f1251bdd 9951@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9952@tab @code{I}
9953@tab
9954See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9955
9956@item reserved
9957@tab @code{j}
9958@tab Reserved for future use
9959
9960@item reserved
9961@tab @code{J}
5d161b24 9962@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9963
f1251bdd 9964@item kill request
104c1213
JM
9965@tab @code{k}
9966@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9967FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9968thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
9969
9970@item reserved
9971@tab @code{l}
5d161b24 9972@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9973
9974@item reserved
9975@tab @code{L}
5d161b24 9976@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9977
9978@item read memory
9979@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9980@tab
9981Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 9982Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
9983using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9984transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9985@item
9986@tab reply @var{XX...}
9987@tab
d4f3574e 9988@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 9989to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
9990sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9991@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9992@item
9993@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9994@tab @var{NN} is errno
9995
9996@item write mem
9997@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
9998@tab
9999Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
10000@var{XX...} is the data.
10001@item
10002@tab reply @code{OK}
10003@tab for success
10004@item
10005@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10006@tab
10007for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
10008written).
10009
10010@item reserved
10011@tab @code{n}
5d161b24 10012@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10013
10014@item reserved
10015@tab @code{N}
5d161b24 10016@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10017
10018@item reserved
10019@tab @code{o}
5d161b24 10020@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10021
10022@item reserved
10023@tab @code{O}
5d161b24 10024@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10025
10026@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
10027@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
10028@tab
10029See write register.
10030@item
10031@tab return @var{r....}
10032@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
10033
f1251bdd 10034@item write reg
104c1213
JM
10035@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
10036@tab
10037Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
10038digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
10039@item
10040@tab reply @code{OK}
10041@tab for success
10042@item
10043@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10044@tab for an error
10045
f1251bdd 10046@item general query
104c1213
JM
10047@tab @code{q}@var{query}
10048@tab
598ca718 10049Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
104c1213 10050have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
10051company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
10052optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
10053must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
10054@item
10055@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 10056@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
10057@item
10058@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10059@tab error reply
10060@item
10061@tab reply @samp{}
10062@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
10063
f1251bdd 10064@item general set
104c1213
JM
10065@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
10066@tab
10067Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
10068naming conventions.
10069
598ca718 10070@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
d4f3574e
SS
10071@tab @code{r}
10072@tab
10073Reset the entire system.
104c1213 10074
f1251bdd 10075@item remote restart
104c1213
JM
10076@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
10077@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10078Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
10079definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
10080packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
104c1213 10081
f1251bdd 10082@item step
104c1213
JM
10083@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
10084@tab
10085@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
10086same address.
10087@item
10088@tab reply
10089@tab see below
10090
f1251bdd 10091@item step with signal
104c1213
JM
10092@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
10093@tab
10094Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
10095@item
10096@tab reply
10097@tab see below
10098
f1251bdd 10099@item search
104c1213
JM
10100@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
10101@tab
10102Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
10103@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 10104bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213 10105
f1251bdd 10106@item thread alive
104c1213
JM
10107@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
10108@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
10109@item
10110@tab reply @code{OK}
10111@tab thread is still alive
10112@item
10113@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10114@tab thread is dead
5d161b24 10115
104c1213
JM
10116@item reserved
10117@tab @code{u}
5d161b24 10118@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10119
10120@item reserved
10121@tab @code{U}
5d161b24 10122@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10123
10124@item reserved
10125@tab @code{v}
5d161b24 10126@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10127
10128@item reserved
10129@tab @code{V}
5d161b24 10130@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10131
10132@item reserved
10133@tab @code{w}
5d161b24 10134@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10135
10136@item reserved
10137@tab @code{W}
5d161b24 10138@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10139
10140@item reserved
10141@tab @code{x}
5d161b24 10142@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10143
f1251bdd 10144@item write mem (binary)
104c1213
JM
10145@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
10146@tab
10147@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
10148binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
10149escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
10150@item
10151@tab reply @code{OK}
10152@tab for success
10153@item
10154@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10155@tab for an error
10156
10157@item reserved
10158@tab @code{y}
5d161b24 10159@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10160
10161@item reserved
10162@tab @code{Y}
5d161b24 10163@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10164
f1251bdd 10165@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10166@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10167@tab
10168See @samp{Z}.
10169
f1251bdd 10170@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10171@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10172@tab
10173@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
10174breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
10175@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
10176bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
10177the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
10178@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
10179potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
6d2ebf8b 10180implemented in an idempotent way.
104c1213
JM
10181@item
10182@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10183@tab for an error
10184@item
10185@tab reply @code{OK}
10186@tab for success
10187@item
10188@tab @samp{}
10189@tab If not supported.
10190
10191@item reserved
10192@tab <other>
5d161b24 10193@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10194
10195@end multitable
10196
d4f3574e
SS
10197The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
10198receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
10199@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
10200when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
10201number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
10202conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
10203
10204@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
10205
10206@item @code{S}@var{AA}
10207@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
10208
10209@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
10210@tab
10211@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
10212(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
10213by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
10214thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 10215starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
10216@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
10217extend the protocol.
10218
10219@item @code{W}@var{AA}
10220@tab
10221The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
10222applicable for certains sorts of targets.
10223
10224@item @code{X}@var{AA}
10225@tab
10226The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
10227
6d2ebf8b 10228@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
104c1213 10229@tab
6d2ebf8b
SS
10230@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
10231@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
10232@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
10233this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
10234spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
10235debugger.}
104c1213
JM
10236
10237@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
10238@tab
c3f6f71d 10239@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
10240while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
10241for 'W', 'T', etc.
10242
10243@end multitable
10244
d4f3574e
SS
10245The following set and query packets have already been defined.
10246
10247@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
10248
10249@item current thread
10250@tab @code{q}@code{C}
10251@tab Return the current thread id.
10252@item
10253@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
10254@tab
10255Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
10256@item
10257@tab reply *
10258@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
10259
bba2971c
MS
10260@item all thread ids
10261@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10262@item
10263@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 10264@tab
bba2971c
MS
10265Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
10266may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
10267works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
10268obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
5d161b24 10269be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
bba2971c 10270sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 10271@item
bba2971c
MS
10272@tab
10273@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 10274@item
5d161b24 10275@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
bba2971c
MS
10276@tab A single thread id
10277@item
00e4a2e4 10278@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
bba2971c
MS
10279@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
10280@item
10281@tab reply @code{l}
10282@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
10283@item
10284@tab
10285@tab
10286In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
10287or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
10288respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
10289@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
10290(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
10291
10292@item extra thread info
480ff1fb 10293@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
bba2971c
MS
10294@tab
10295@item
10296@tab
10297@tab
10298Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
10299Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
10300the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
10301thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
10302The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
5d161b24 10303Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
bba2971c
MS
10304"Blocked on Mutex".
10305@item
10306@tab reply @var{XX...}
10307@tab
10308Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
10309printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
10310attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
10311
10312@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
10313@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
10314@tab
2b628194
MS
10315@item
10316@tab
10317@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10318Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
10319digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
10320subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
10321number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
10322(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
10323returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
10324@item
bba2971c
MS
10325@tab
10326@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10327query (see above).
10328@item
d4f3574e
SS
10329@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
10330@tab
2b628194
MS
10331@item
10332@tab
10333@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10334Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
10335returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
10336and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
10337digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
10338a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
10339digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
10340
bba2971c
MS
10341@item compute CRC of memory block
10342@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10343@tab
10344@item
10345@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10346@tab An error (such as memory fault)
10347@item
10348@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
10349@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
10350
d4f3574e
SS
10351@item query sect offs
10352@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
10353@tab
10354Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
10355image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
10356response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
10357offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
10358@item
10359@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
10360
10361@item thread info request
10362@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
10363@tab
598ca718
EZ
10364@item
10365@tab
10366@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10367Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
10368encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
10369@item
10370@tab reply *
10371@tab
10372See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
10373
10374@item remote command
10375@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
10376@tab
598ca718
EZ
10377@item
10378@tab
10379@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10380@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
10381execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
10382Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
10383number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
10384packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
10385stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
10386@item
10387@tab reply @code{OK}
10388@tab
10389A command response with no output.
10390@item
10391@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
10392@tab
10393A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
10394@item
10395@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10396@tab
10397Indicate a badly formed request.
10398
10399@item
10400@tab reply @samp{}
10401@tab
10402When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
10403
10404@end multitable
10405
10406The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
10407In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
10408bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
10409space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
10410The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
10411least-significant.
10412
10413@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
10414
10415@item MIPS32
10416@tab
10417All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1041832 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
10419registers; fsr; fir; fp.
10420
10421@item MIPS64
10422@tab
10423All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
10424thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
10425as @code{MIPS32}.
10426
10427@end multitable
10428
104c1213
JM
10429Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
10430does not get any direct output:
10431
10432@example
10433<- @code{R00}
10434-> @code{+}
10435@emph{target restarts}
10436<- @code{?}
10437-> @code{+}
10438-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10439<- @code{+}
10440@end example
10441
10442Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
10443
10444@example
10445<- @code{G1445...}
10446-> @code{+}
10447<- @code{s}
10448-> @code{+}
10449@emph{time passes}
10450-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10451<- @code{+}
10452<- @code{g}
10453-> @code{+}
10454-> @code{1455...}
10455<- @code{+}
10456@end example
10457
6d2ebf8b 10458@node Server
104c1213
JM
10459@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10460
10461@kindex gdbserver
10462@cindex remote connection without stubs
10463@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10464allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10465@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10466
10467@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10468because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10469that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10470@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10471@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10472because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10473also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10474started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10475Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10476the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10477do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10478by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10479choice for debugging.
10480
10481@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10482or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10483protocol.
10484
10485@table @emph
10486@item On the target machine,
10487you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10488@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10489strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10490system does all the symbol handling.
10491
10492To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10493the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
10494syntax is:
10495
10496@smallexample
10497target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10498@end smallexample
10499
10500@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10501hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10502@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10503@file{/dev/com1}:
10504
10505@smallexample
10506target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10507@end smallexample
10508
10509@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10510with it.
10511
10512To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10513
10514@smallexample
10515target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10516@end smallexample
10517
10518The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10519specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10520TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10521expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10522(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10523you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10524TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10525reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10526conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 10527and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
10528@code{target remote} command.
10529
10530@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10531you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10532symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10533using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10534(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10535running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10536remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10537is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10538@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10539@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10540
10541@smallexample
10542(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10543@end smallexample
10544
10545@noindent
10546communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10547
10548@smallexample
10549(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10550@end smallexample
10551
10552@noindent
10553communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10554For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10555the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10556text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10557@samp{Connection refused}.
10558@end table
10559
6d2ebf8b 10560@node NetWare
104c1213
JM
10561@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10562
10563@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10564@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10565allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10566@code{target remote}.
10567
10568@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10569using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10570
10571@table @emph
10572@item On the target machine,
10573you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10574@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10575can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10576host system does all the symbol handling.
10577
10578To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10579@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10580program. The syntax is:
10581
5d161b24 10582@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10583load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10584 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10585@end smallexample
10586
10587@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10588the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 10589to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
10590
10591For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
5d161b24 10592communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 10593using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
10594
10595@smallexample
10596load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10597@end smallexample
10598
10599@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10600you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10601symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10602using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10603(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10604running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10605remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10606argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10607@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10608
10609@smallexample
10610(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10611@end smallexample
10612
10613@noindent
10614communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10615@end table
10616
6d2ebf8b 10617@node KOD
104c1213
JM
10618@section Kernel Object Display
10619
10620@cindex kernel object display
10621@cindex kernel object
10622@cindex KOD
10623
10624Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10625@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10626and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10627mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10628displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10629
10630Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10631@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10632
10633@example
2df3850c 10634(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
10635@end example
10636
10637If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10638about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10639which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10640after the operating system:
10641
10642@example
2df3850c 10643(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
10644List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10645Object Description
10646any Any and all objects
10647@end example
10648
10649Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10650by the kernel.
10651
10652There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
10653is supported other than to try it.
10654
10655
6d2ebf8b 10656@node Configurations
104c1213
JM
10657@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10658
10659While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10660cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10661describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10662
10663There are three major categories of configurations: native
10664configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10665operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10666different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10667are quite different from each other.
10668
10669@menu
10670* Native::
10671* Embedded OS::
10672* Embedded Processors::
10673* Architectures::
10674@end menu
10675
6d2ebf8b 10676@node Native
104c1213
JM
10677@section Native
10678
10679This section describes details specific to particular native
10680configurations.
10681
10682@menu
10683* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10684* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10685@end menu
10686
6d2ebf8b 10687@node HP-UX
104c1213
JM
10688@subsection HP-UX
10689
10690On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10691begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10692name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10693
6d2ebf8b 10694@node SVR4 Process Information
104c1213
JM
10695@subsection SVR4 process information
10696
10697@kindex /proc
10698@cindex process image
10699
10700Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10701used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10702subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10703this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10704several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10705@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10706@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10707and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10708
10709@table @code
10710@kindex info proc
10711@item info proc
10712Summarize available information about the process.
10713
10714@kindex info proc mappings
10715@item info proc mappings
10716Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10717on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10718
10719@kindex info proc times
10720@item info proc times
10721Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10722its children.
10723
10724@kindex info proc id
10725@item info proc id
10726Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10727the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10728
10729@kindex info proc status
10730@item info proc status
10731General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10732stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10733received.
10734
10735@item info proc all
10736Show all the above information about the process.
10737@end table
10738
6d2ebf8b 10739@node Embedded OS
104c1213
JM
10740@section Embedded Operating Systems
10741
10742This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10743embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10744architectures.
10745
10746@menu
10747* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10748@end menu
10749
10750@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10751various real-time operating systems.
10752
6d2ebf8b 10753@node VxWorks
104c1213
JM
10754@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10755
10756@cindex VxWorks
10757
10758@table @code
10759
10760@kindex target vxworks
10761@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10762A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10763is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10764
10765@end table
10766
10767On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10768current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
10769
10770@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10771VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10772the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10773both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 10774@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 10775installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 10776@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
10777
10778@table @code
10779@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10780@kindex vxworks-timeout
5d161b24
DB
10781All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10782This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10783seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10784your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
104c1213
JM
10785of a thin network line.
10786@end table
10787
10788The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10789this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10790procedures.
10791
10792@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10793To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10794to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10795library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10796VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10797kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10798source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10799information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10800manual.
10801@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
10802
10803Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10804your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
10805run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10806@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
10807
10808@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10809
10810@example
10811(vxgdb)
10812@end example
10813
10814@menu
10815* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10816* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10817* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10818@end menu
10819
6d2ebf8b 10820@node VxWorks Connection
104c1213
JM
10821@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10822
10823The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10824network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10825
10826@example
10827(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10828@end example
10829
10830@need 750
10831@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10832
10833@smallexample
5d161b24 10834Attaching remote machine across net...
104c1213
JM
10835Connected to tt.
10836@end smallexample
10837
10838@need 1000
10839@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10840loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10841these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10842path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10843to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10844
10845@example
10846prog.o: No such file or directory.
10847@end example
10848
10849When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10850the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10851command again.
10852
6d2ebf8b 10853@node VxWorks Download
104c1213
JM
10854@subsubsection VxWorks download
10855
10856@cindex download to VxWorks
10857If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10858object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10859@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10860incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10861command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10862to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10863table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10864the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10865filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10866Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10867to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10868the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10869@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10870and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10871program, type this on VxWorks:
10872
10873@example
10874-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10875@end example
d4f3574e
SS
10876
10877@noindent
104c1213
JM
10878Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10879
10880@example
5d161b24 10881(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
104c1213
JM
10882(vxgdb) load prog.o
10883@end example
10884
10885@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10886
10887@smallexample
10888Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10889@end smallexample
10890
10891You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10892after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10893this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10894auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10895history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 10896debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
10897table.)
10898
6d2ebf8b 10899@node VxWorks Attach
104c1213
JM
10900@subsubsection Running tasks
10901
10902@cindex running VxWorks tasks
10903You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10904follows:
10905
10906@example
10907(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10908@end example
10909
10910@noindent
10911where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10912or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10913the time of attachment.
10914
6d2ebf8b 10915@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
10916@section Embedded Processors
10917
10918This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10919configurations.
10920
10921@menu
10922* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10923* ARM:: ARM
10924* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10925* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10926* i960:: Intel i960
10927* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10928* M68K:: Motorola M68K
10929* M88K:: Motorola M88K
10930* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10931* PA:: HP PA Embedded
10932* PowerPC: PowerPC
10933* SH:: Hitachi SH
10934* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10935* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10936* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10937* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10938@end menu
10939
6d2ebf8b 10940@node A29K Embedded
104c1213
JM
10941@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10942
10943@menu
10944* A29K UDI::
10945* A29K EB29K::
10946* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
10947* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
10948* Remote Log:: Remote log
10949@end menu
10950
10951@table @code
10952
10953@kindex target adapt
10954@item target adapt @var{dev}
10955Adapt monitor for A29K.
10956
10957@kindex target amd-eb
10958@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
10959@cindex AMD EB29K
10960Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
10961@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
10962@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
10963name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
10964@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
10965
10966@end table
10967
6d2ebf8b 10968@node A29K UDI
104c1213
JM
10969@subsubsection A29K UDI
10970
10971@cindex UDI
10972@cindex AMD29K via UDI
10973
10974@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
10975protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
10976configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
10977program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
10978use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
10979@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
10980
10981@table @code
10982@item target udi @var{keyword}
10983@kindex udi
10984Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
10985@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
10986This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
10987connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
10988working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
10989to its pathname.
10990@end table
10991
6d2ebf8b 10992@node A29K EB29K
104c1213
JM
10993@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
10994
10995@cindex EB29K board
10996@cindex running 29K programs
10997
10998AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10999with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
11000term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
11001@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
11002must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
11003board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
11004assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
11005@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
11006
6d2ebf8b 11007@node Comms (EB29K)
104c1213
JM
11008@subsubsection Communications setup
11009
11010The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
11011in DOS on the PC:
11012
11013@example
11014C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
11015@end example
11016
11017@noindent
11018This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
11019bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
11020you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
11021end of the connection as well.
11022@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
5d161b24 11023@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11024@c
11025@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
11026@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
11027@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
11028@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
11029@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
11030
11031To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
11032the following at the DOS console:
11033
11034@example
11035C:\> CTTY com1
11036@end example
11037
11038@noindent
11039(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
11040the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 11041had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
11042
11043From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
11044@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
11045
11046@example
11047cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
11048@end example
11049
11050@noindent
11051The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
11052serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
11053may look something like the following:
11054
11055@example
11056tip -9600 /dev/ttya
11057@end example
11058
11059@noindent
11060Your system may require a different name where we show
11061@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
11062parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
11063@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
11064system table @file{/etc/remote}.
11065@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
11066@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
11067@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
11068@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
11069@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
11070@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
11071@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11072@c
11073@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11074@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11075@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
11076
11077@kindex EBMON
11078Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11079directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11080start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11081with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
11082@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11083@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11084
11085@example
11086C:\> G:
11087
11088G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11089
11090G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11091Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11092Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11093Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11094
11095Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11096
11097PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
11098I/O Base = 0x208
11099Memory Base = 0xd0000
11100
11101Data Memory Size = 2048KB
11102Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11103Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11104
11105PageSize = 0x400
11106Register Stack Size = 0x800
11107Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
11108
11109CPU PRL = 0x3
11110Am29027 Available = No
11111Byte Write Available = Yes
11112
11113# ~.
11114@end example
11115
11116Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11117typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
11118running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11119
11120For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11121way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 11122system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
11123PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
11124something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11125other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11126from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11127serial line.
11128
6d2ebf8b 11129@node gdb-EB29K
104c1213
JM
11130@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11131
11132Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11133program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11134name of your 29K program:
11135
11136@example
11137cd /usr/joe/work29k
11138@value{GDBP} myfoo
11139@end example
11140
11141@need 500
11142Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11143
11144@example
11145target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11146@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
11147@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11148@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11149@end example
11150
11151@noindent
11152In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11153@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11154@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11155In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11156a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11157the name on the Unix side.
11158
11159At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11160to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11161@code{run}.
11162
11163To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11164command.
11165
11166To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11167once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11168@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11169@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 11170Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
11171and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11172
6d2ebf8b 11173@node Remote Log
104c1213 11174@subsubsection Remote log
41afff9a 11175@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
104c1213
JM
11176@cindex log file for EB29K
11177
11178The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
11179current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
11180@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
11181of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
11182another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
11183unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
11184
6d2ebf8b 11185@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11186@subsection ARM
11187
11188@table @code
11189
11190@kindex target rdi
11191@item target rdi @var{dev}
11192ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11193use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11194monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
5d161b24 11195
104c1213
JM
11196@kindex target rdp
11197@item target rdp @var{dev}
11198ARM Demon monitor.
11199
11200@end table
11201
6d2ebf8b 11202@node H8/300
104c1213
JM
11203@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11204
11205@table @code
11206
d4f3574e 11207@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11208@item target hms @var{dev}
11209A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11210Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11211line and the communications speed used.
11212
d4f3574e 11213@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11214@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11215E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11216
d4f3574e
SS
11217@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11218@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 11219@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 11220@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
11221Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11222
11223@end table
11224
11225@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11226@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11227@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11228@cindex Hitachi SH download
11229When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11230board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11231board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11232@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11233
11234@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
5d161b24 11235Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
104c1213
JM
11236
11237@enumerate
11238@item
11239that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11240for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11241emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 11242the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
11243H8/300, or H8/500.)
11244
11245@item
11246what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11247serial device available on your host is the default).
11248
11249@item
11250what speed to use over the serial device.
11251@end enumerate
11252
11253@menu
11254* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11255* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11256* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11257@end menu
11258
6d2ebf8b 11259@node Hitachi Boards
104c1213
JM
11260@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11261
11262@c only for Unix hosts
11263@kindex device
11264@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11265Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
11266need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11267first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11268hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11269
11270@kindex speed
11271@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11272@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 11273speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 11274hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
11275the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11276@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
11277
11278The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11279use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11280use a DOS host,
11281@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11282called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11283through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11284to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11285
11286The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11287program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11288sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11289the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11290
11291First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11292board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11293port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11294When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 11295debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
11296for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11297@code{COM2}.
11298
11299@example
11300C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11301C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11302
11303Resident portion of MODE loaded
11304
11305COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11306
11307@end example
11308
11309@quotation
11310@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11311@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11312disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11313your development board.
11314@end quotation
11315
d4f3574e 11316@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
11317Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11318connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 11319the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
11320you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11321commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11322cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11323download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11324the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11325(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11326executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11327@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11328itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11329
11330@smallexample
11331(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 11332@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 11333 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
104c1213 11334 the conditions.
5d161b24 11335There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 11336for details.
2df3850c
JM
11337@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11338(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 11339Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 11340(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
11341.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11342.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11343.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11344@end smallexample
11345
11346At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11347you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11348sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11349@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11350resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11351@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11352
11353Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11354available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11355you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11356
11357Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11358@itemize @bullet
11359@item
11360to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11361no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11362
11363@item
11364to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11365normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11366to detect program completion.
11367@end itemize
11368
11369In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11370development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11371
6d2ebf8b 11372@node Hitachi ICE
104c1213
JM
11373@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11374
d4f3574e 11375@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
11376You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11377Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11378e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11379
11380@table @code
11381@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11382Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11383@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11384@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11385(for example, @samp{9600}).
11386
11387@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11388If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11389specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11390@end table
11391
6d2ebf8b 11392@node Hitachi Special
104c1213
JM
11393@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11394
11395Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11396
11397@table @code
11398
11399@kindex set machine
11400@kindex show machine
11401@item set machine h8300
11402@itemx set machine h8300h
11403Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11404architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11405to check which variant is currently in effect.
11406
11407@end table
11408
6d2ebf8b 11409@node H8/500
104c1213
JM
11410@subsection H8/500
11411
11412@table @code
11413
11414@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11415@cindex memory models, H8/500
11416@item set memory @var{mod}
11417@itemx show memory
11418Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11419@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11420memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11421@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11422
11423@end table
11424
6d2ebf8b 11425@node i960
104c1213
JM
11426@subsection Intel i960
11427
11428@table @code
11429
11430@kindex target mon960
11431@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11432MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11433
f0ca3dce 11434@kindex target nindy
104c1213
JM
11435@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11436An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11437the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11438@file{/dev/ttya}.
11439
11440@end table
11441
11442@cindex Nindy
11443@cindex i960
11444@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11445@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11446tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11447
11448@itemize @bullet
11449@item
11450Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11451Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11452
11453@item
11454By responding to a prompt on startup;
11455
11456@item
11457By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11458session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11459
104c1213
JM
11460@end itemize
11461
11462@cindex download to Nindy-960
11463With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11464downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11465@value{GDBN}.
11466
11467@menu
11468* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11469* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11470* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11471@end menu
11472
6d2ebf8b 11473@node Nindy Startup
104c1213
JM
11474@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11475
11476If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11477options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11478reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11479
11480@example
5d161b24 11481Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
104c1213
JM
11482@end example
11483
11484@noindent
11485Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11486identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11487simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11488with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11489use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11490
6d2ebf8b 11491@node Nindy Options
104c1213
JM
11492@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11493
11494These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11495Nindy-960 board attached:
11496
11497@table @code
11498@item -r @var{port}
11499Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11500to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11501configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11502@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11503device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11504suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11505
11506@item -O
11507(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11508the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11509This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11510target architecture.
11511
11512@quotation
11513@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11514connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11515fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11516attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11517this process with an interrupt.
11518@end quotation
11519
11520@item -brk
11521Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11522system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11523
11524@quotation
11525@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11526requires; it only works with a few boards.
11527@end quotation
11528@end table
11529
11530The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11531port.
11532
11533@c @group
6d2ebf8b 11534@node Nindy Reset
104c1213
JM
11535@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11536
11537@table @code
11538@item reset
11539@kindex reset
11540For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11541system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11542circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11543a break is detected.
11544@end table
11545@c @end group
11546
6d2ebf8b 11547@node M32R/D
104c1213
JM
11548@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11549
11550@table @code
11551
11552@kindex target m32r
11553@item target m32r @var{dev}
11554Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11555
11556@end table
11557
6d2ebf8b 11558@node M68K
104c1213
JM
11559@subsection M68k
11560
11561The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11562target command for the following ROM monitors.
11563
11564@table @code
11565
11566@kindex target abug
11567@item target abug @var{dev}
11568ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11569
11570@kindex target cpu32bug
11571@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11572CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11573
11574@kindex target dbug
11575@item target dbug @var{dev}
11576dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11577
11578@kindex target est
11579@item target est @var{dev}
11580EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11581
11582@kindex target rom68k
11583@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11584ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11585
11586@end table
11587
11588If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11589instead have only a single special target command:
11590
11591@table @code
11592
11593@kindex target es1800
11594@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11595ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11596
11597@end table
11598
11599[context?]
11600
11601@table @code
11602
11603@kindex target rombug
11604@item target rombug @var{dev}
11605ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11606
11607@end table
11608
6d2ebf8b 11609@node M88K
104c1213
JM
11610@subsection M88K
11611
11612@table @code
11613
11614@kindex target bug
11615@item target bug @var{dev}
11616BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11617
11618@end table
11619
6d2ebf8b 11620@node MIPS Embedded
104c1213
JM
11621@subsection MIPS Embedded
11622
11623@cindex MIPS boards
11624@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11625MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11626you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11627
11628@need 1000
11629Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11630
11631@table @code
11632@item target mips @var{port}
11633@kindex target mips @var{port}
11634To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11635name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11636command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11637the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11638been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11639download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11640
11641For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11642port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11643debugger:
11644
11645@example
11646host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
11647@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11648(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11649(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11650(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
11651@end example
11652
11653@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11654On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11655connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11656concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11657@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11658
11659@item target pmon @var{port}
11660@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11661PMON ROM monitor.
11662
11663@item target ddb @var{port}
11664@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11665NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11666
11667@item target lsi @var{port}
11668@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11669LSI variant of PMON.
11670
11671@kindex target r3900
11672@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11673Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11674
11675@kindex target array
11676@item target array @var{dev}
11677Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11678
11679@end table
11680
11681
11682@noindent
11683@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11684
11685@table @code
11686@item set processor @var{args}
11687@itemx show processor
11688@kindex set processor @var{args}
11689@kindex show processor
11690Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11691processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
5d161b24 11692For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
96c405b3 11693to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
5d161b24 11694Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
104c1213 11695is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
5d161b24 11696@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213
JM
11697
11698@item set mipsfpu double
11699@itemx set mipsfpu single
11700@itemx set mipsfpu none
11701@itemx show mipsfpu
11702@kindex set mipsfpu
11703@kindex show mipsfpu
11704@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11705@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11706If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11707coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 11708need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
11709file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11710functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11711@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11712functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11713with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11714processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11715double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11716@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11717
11718In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11719floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11720and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11721
11722As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11723@samp{show mipsfpu}.
11724
11725@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11726@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
11727@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11728@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
11729@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11730@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11731@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11732@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11733You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11734by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11735@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11736to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11737at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11738
11739@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11740@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11741@itemx show timeout
11742@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11743@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11744@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11745@kindex set timeout
11746@kindex show timeout
11747@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11748@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11749You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11750remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11751default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11752waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11753retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11754You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11755retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11756@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11757
11758The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11759is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11760forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11761to run before stopping.
11762@end table
11763
6d2ebf8b 11764@node PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11765@subsection PowerPC
11766
11767@table @code
11768
11769@kindex target dink32
11770@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11771DINK32 ROM monitor.
11772
11773@kindex target ppcbug
11774@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11775@kindex target ppcbug1
11776@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11777PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11778
11779@kindex target sds
11780@item target sds @var{dev}
11781SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11782
11783@end table
11784
6d2ebf8b 11785@node PA
104c1213
JM
11786@subsection HP PA Embedded
11787
11788@table @code
11789
11790@kindex target op50n
11791@item target op50n @var{dev}
11792OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11793
11794@kindex target w89k
11795@item target w89k @var{dev}
11796W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11797
11798@end table
11799
6d2ebf8b 11800@node SH
104c1213
JM
11801@subsection Hitachi SH
11802
11803@table @code
11804
d4f3574e 11805@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11806@item target hms @var{dev}
11807A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11808commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11809the communications speed used.
11810
d4f3574e 11811@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11812@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11813E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11814
d4f3574e
SS
11815@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11816@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
11817@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11818@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11819Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11820
11821@end table
11822
6d2ebf8b 11823@node Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11824@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11825
11826@cindex Sparclet
11827
5d161b24
DB
11828@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11829Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11830@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11831both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
5d161b24 11832@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11833
11834@table @code
f0ca3dce 11835@item remotetimeout @var{args}
104c1213 11836@kindex remotetimeout
5d161b24
DB
11837@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11838This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11839seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11840@end table
11841
41afff9a 11842@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
5d161b24 11843When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
d4f3574e 11844information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
5d161b24 11845load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
d4f3574e 11846@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
11847
11848@example
11849sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11850@end example
11851
d4f3574e 11852You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
11853
11854@example
11855sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11856@end example
11857
41afff9a 11858@cindex running, on Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11859Once you have set
11860your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
5d161b24 11861run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
11862(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11863
11864@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11865
11866@example
11867(gdbslet)
11868@end example
11869
11870@menu
11871* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11872* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11873* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
5d161b24 11874* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11875@end menu
11876
6d2ebf8b 11877@node Sparclet File
104c1213
JM
11878@subsubsection Setting file to debug
11879
11880The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11881
11882@example
11883(gdbslet) file prog
11884@end example
11885
11886@need 1000
11887@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11888@value{GDBN} locates
11889the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11890path.
11891If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11892files will be searched as well.
11893@value{GDBN} locates
11894the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11895path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11896If it fails
11897to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11898
11899@example
11900prog: No such file or directory.
11901@end example
11902
11903When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
5d161b24 11904the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
104c1213
JM
11905@code{target} command again.
11906
6d2ebf8b 11907@node Sparclet Connection
104c1213
JM
11908@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11909
11910The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11911To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11912
11913@example
11914(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11915Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
5d161b24 11916main () at ../prog.c:3
104c1213
JM
11917@end example
11918
11919@need 750
11920@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11921
d4f3574e 11922@example
104c1213 11923Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 11924@end example
104c1213 11925
6d2ebf8b 11926@node Sparclet Download
104c1213
JM
11927@subsubsection Sparclet download
11928
11929@cindex download to Sparclet
5d161b24 11930Once connected to the Sparclet target,
104c1213
JM
11931you can use the @value{GDBN}
11932@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11933The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11934command.
5d161b24 11935Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 11936address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
11937offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11938of each of the file's sections.
11939For instance, if the program
11940@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11941and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11942
11943@example
11944(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11945Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11946@end example
11947
5d161b24
DB
11948If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11949to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
104c1213
JM
11950to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11951
6d2ebf8b 11952@node Sparclet Execution
104c1213
JM
11953@subsubsection Running and debugging
11954
11955@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11956You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
5d161b24 11957commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
11958manual for the list of commands.
11959
11960@example
11961(gdbslet) b main
11962Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
5d161b24 11963(gdbslet) run
104c1213
JM
11964Starting program: prog
11965Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
119663 char *symarg = 0;
11967(gdbslet) step
119684 char *execarg = "hello!";
5d161b24 11969(gdbslet)
104c1213
JM
11970@end example
11971
6d2ebf8b 11972@node Sparclite
104c1213
JM
11973@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
11974
11975@table @code
11976
11977@kindex target sparclite
11978@item target sparclite @var{dev}
5d161b24
DB
11979Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11980You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11981For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
104c1213
JM
11982remote protocol.
11983
11984@end table
11985
6d2ebf8b 11986@node ST2000
104c1213
JM
11987@subsection Tandem ST2000
11988
2df3850c 11989@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
11990STDBUG protocol.
11991
11992To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11993manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
11994
11995@example
11996target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11997@end example
11998
11999@noindent
12000to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12001the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12002ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12003connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12004concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12005
12006The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12007this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12008would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12009(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12010available on your host computer.
12011@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12012@c basically hearsay.
12013
12014@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12015These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12016environment:
12017
12018@table @code
12019@item st2000 @var{command}
12020@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12021@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12022@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12023Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12024manual for available commands.
12025
12026@item connect
12027@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12028Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12029you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12030sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12031@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12032@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12033@end table
12034
6d2ebf8b 12035@node Z8000
104c1213
JM
12036@subsection Zilog Z8000
12037
12038@cindex Z8000
12039@cindex simulator, Z8000
12040@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12041
12042When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12043a Z8000 simulator.
12044
12045For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12046unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12047segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12048appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12049
12050@table @code
12051@item target sim @var{args}
12052@kindex sim
d4f3574e 12053@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
12054Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12055options, specify them via @var{args}.
12056@end table
12057
12058@noindent
12059After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12060CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12061@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12062to run your program, and so on.
12063
d4f3574e
SS
12064As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12065(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12066additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12067
12068@table @code
12069
12070@item cycles
12071Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12072
12073@item insts
12074Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12075
12076@item time
12077Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12078
12079@end table
12080
12081You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12082conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12083conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12084simulated clock ticks.
12085
6d2ebf8b 12086@node Architectures
104c1213
JM
12087@section Architectures
12088
12089This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 12090all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
12091
12092@menu
12093* A29K::
12094* Alpha::
12095* MIPS::
12096@end menu
12097
6d2ebf8b 12098@node A29K
104c1213
JM
12099@subsection A29K
12100
12101@table @code
12102
12103@kindex set rstack_high_address
12104@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12105@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12106@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12107On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 12108@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
12109extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12110stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12111memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12112this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12113the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12114address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12115hexadecimal.
12116
12117@kindex show rstack_high_address
12118@item show rstack_high_address
12119Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12120processors.
12121
12122@end table
12123
6d2ebf8b 12124@node Alpha
104c1213
JM
12125@subsection Alpha
12126
12127See the following section.
12128
6d2ebf8b 12129@node MIPS
104c1213
JM
12130@subsection MIPS
12131
12132@cindex stack on Alpha
12133@cindex stack on MIPS
12134@cindex Alpha stack
12135@cindex MIPS stack
12136Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12137sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12138find the beginning of a function.
12139
12140@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12141To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12142@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12143you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12144commands:
12145
12146@table @code
00e4a2e4 12147@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
104c1213
JM
12148@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12149Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12150search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12151default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12152larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12153and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12154
12155@item show heuristic-fence-post
12156Display the current limit.
12157@end table
12158
12159@noindent
12160These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12161for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12162
12163
6d2ebf8b 12164@node Controlling GDB
c906108c
SS
12165@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12166
53a5351d
JM
12167You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12168@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 12169data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 12170described here.
c906108c
SS
12171
12172@menu
12173* Prompt:: Prompt
12174* Editing:: Command editing
12175* History:: Command history
12176* Screen Size:: Screen size
12177* Numbers:: Numbers
12178* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
5d161b24 12179* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
c906108c
SS
12180@end menu
12181
6d2ebf8b 12182@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
12183@section Prompt
12184
12185@cindex prompt
12186
12187@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12188called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12189can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12190instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
5d161b24 12191the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
c906108c
SS
12192which one you are talking to.
12193
d4f3574e 12194@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
12195prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12196or a prompt that does not.
12197
12198@table @code
12199@kindex set prompt
12200@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12201Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12202
12203@kindex show prompt
12204@item show prompt
12205Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12206@end table
12207
6d2ebf8b 12208@node Editing
c906108c
SS
12209@section Command editing
12210@cindex readline
12211@cindex command line editing
12212
12213@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12214@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12215command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12216or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12217substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12218debugging sessions.
12219
12220You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12221command @code{set}.
12222
12223@table @code
12224@kindex set editing
12225@cindex editing
12226@item set editing
12227@itemx set editing on
12228Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12229
12230@item set editing off
12231Disable command line editing.
12232
12233@kindex show editing
12234@item show editing
12235Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12236@end table
12237
6d2ebf8b 12238@node History
c906108c
SS
12239@section Command history
12240
12241@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12242debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12243happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12244history facility.
12245
12246@table @code
12247@cindex history substitution
12248@cindex history file
12249@kindex set history filename
12250@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12251@item set history filename @var{fname}
12252Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12253This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12254list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12255exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12256the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12257to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
12258@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12259is not set.
c906108c
SS
12260
12261@cindex history save
12262@kindex set history save
12263@item set history save
12264@itemx set history save on
12265Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12266@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12267
12268@item set history save off
12269Stop recording command history in a file.
12270
12271@cindex history size
12272@kindex set history size
12273@item set history size @var{size}
12274Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12275This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12276@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12277@end table
12278
12279@cindex history expansion
12280History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12281@ifset have-readline-appendices
12282@xref{Event Designators}.
12283@end ifset
12284
12285Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12286is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12287@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12288follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12289a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12290history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12291@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12292
12293The commands to control history expansion are:
12294
12295@table @code
12296@kindex set history expansion
12297@item set history expansion on
12298@itemx set history expansion
12299Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12300
12301@item set history expansion off
12302Disable history expansion.
12303
12304The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12305editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12306or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12307@ifset have-readline-appendices
12308@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12309@end ifset
12310
12311@c @group
12312@kindex show history
12313@item show history
12314@itemx show history filename
12315@itemx show history save
12316@itemx show history size
12317@itemx show history expansion
12318These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12319@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12320@c @end group
12321@end table
12322
12323@table @code
41afff9a 12324@kindex shows
c906108c
SS
12325@item show commands
12326Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12327
12328@item show commands @var{n}
12329Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12330
12331@item show commands +
12332Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12333@end table
12334
6d2ebf8b 12335@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
12336@section Screen size
12337@cindex size of screen
12338@cindex pauses in output
12339
12340Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12341information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12342@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12343output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12344to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12345determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12346printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12347rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12348
d4f3574e
SS
12349Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12350driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 12351together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 12352@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
12353you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12354width} commands:
12355
12356@table @code
12357@kindex set height
12358@kindex set width
12359@kindex show width
12360@kindex show height
12361@item set height @var{lpp}
12362@itemx show height
12363@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12364@itemx show width
12365These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12366a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12367commands display the current settings.
12368
5d161b24
DB
12369If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12370output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
c906108c
SS
12371file or to an editor buffer.
12372
12373Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12374from wrapping its output.
12375@end table
12376
6d2ebf8b 12377@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
12378@section Numbers
12379@cindex number representation
12380@cindex entering numbers
12381
2df3850c
JM
12382You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12383@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12384@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12385begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12386default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12387numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12388change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12389radix} command.
c906108c
SS
12390
12391@table @code
12392@kindex set input-radix
12393@item set input-radix @var{base}
12394Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12395for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12396specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12397example, any of
12398
12399@smallexample
12400set radix 012
12401set radix 10.
12402set radix 0xa
12403@end smallexample
12404
12405@noindent
12406sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12407leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12408
12409@kindex set output-radix
12410@item set output-radix @var{base}
12411Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12412for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12413specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12414
12415@kindex show input-radix
12416@item show input-radix
12417Display the current default base for numeric input.
12418
12419@kindex show output-radix
12420@item show output-radix
12421Display the current default base for numeric display.
12422@end table
12423
6d2ebf8b 12424@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
12425@section Optional warnings and messages
12426
2df3850c
JM
12427By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12428running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12429command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12430internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
12431
12432Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12433which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12434see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12435
12436@table @code
12437@kindex set verbose
12438@item set verbose on
12439Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12440
12441@item set verbose off
12442Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12443
12444@kindex show verbose
12445@item show verbose
12446Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12447@end table
12448
2df3850c
JM
12449By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12450object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12451find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12452symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
12453
12454@table @code
2df3850c 12455
c906108c
SS
12456@kindex set complaints
12457@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
12458Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12459unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12460@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12461to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
12462
12463@kindex show complaints
12464@item show complaints
12465Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 12466
c906108c
SS
12467@end table
12468
12469By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12470lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12471you try to run a program which is already running:
12472
12473@example
12474(@value{GDBP}) run
12475The program being debugged has been started already.
12476Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12477@end example
12478
12479If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12480commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12481
12482@table @code
2df3850c 12483
c906108c
SS
12484@kindex set confirm
12485@cindex flinching
12486@cindex confirmation
12487@cindex stupid questions
12488@item set confirm off
12489Disables confirmation requests.
12490
12491@item set confirm on
12492Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12493
12494@kindex show confirm
12495@item show confirm
12496Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 12497
c906108c
SS
12498@end table
12499
6d2ebf8b 12500@node Debugging Output
5d161b24
DB
12501@section Optional messages about internal happenings
12502@table @code
12503@kindex set debug arch
12504@item set debug arch
12505Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12506@kindex show debug arch
12507@item show debug arch
12508Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12509@kindex set debug event
12510@item set debug event
12511Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12512default is off.
12513@kindex show debug event
12514@item show debug event
12515Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12516info.
12517@kindex set debug expression
12518@item set debug expression
12519Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12520default is off.
12521@kindex show debug expression
12522@item show debug expression
12523Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12524debugging info.
12525@kindex set debug overload
12526@item set debug overload
b37052ae 12527Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
5d161b24
DB
12528info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12529is off.
12530@kindex show debug overload
12531@item show debug overload
b37052ae 12532Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
5d161b24
DB
12533debugging info.
12534@kindex set debug remote
12535@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12536@cindex serial connections, debugging
12537@item set debug remote
12538Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12539the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12540@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12541@kindex show debug remote
12542@item show debug remote
12543Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12544@kindex set debug serial
12545@item set debug serial
12546Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12547default is off.
12548@kindex show debug serial
12549@item show debug serial
12550Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12551info.
12552@kindex set debug target
12553@item set debug target
12554Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12555includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12556default is off.
12557@kindex show debug target
12558@item show debug target
12559Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12560info.
12561@kindex set debug varobj
12562@item set debug varobj
12563Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12564info. The default is off.
12565@kindex show debug varobj
12566@item show debug varobj
12567Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12568debugging info.
12569@end table
12570
6d2ebf8b 12571@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
12572@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
12573
12574Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
12575command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12576commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12577files.
c906108c
SS
12578
12579@menu
12580* Define:: User-defined commands
12581* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12582* Command Files:: Command files
12583* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12584@end menu
12585
6d2ebf8b 12586@node Define
c906108c
SS
12587@section User-defined commands
12588
12589@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
12590A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12591which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12592@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12593separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12594via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
12595
12596@smallexample
12597define adder
12598 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12599@end smallexample
12600
d4f3574e
SS
12601@noindent
12602To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
12603
12604@smallexample
12605adder 1 2 3
12606@end smallexample
12607
d4f3574e
SS
12608@noindent
12609This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
5d161b24 12610its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
c906108c
SS
12611reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12612functions calls.
12613
12614@table @code
2df3850c 12615
c906108c
SS
12616@kindex define
12617@item define @var{commandname}
12618Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12619by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
12620
12621The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12622which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12623commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12624
12625@kindex if
12626@kindex else
12627@item if
12628Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12629It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12630only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12631There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12632by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12633was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12634
12635@kindex while
12636@item while
12637The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12638which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12639execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12640The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12641evaluates to true.
12642
12643@kindex document
12644@item document @var{commandname}
12645Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
5d161b24
DB
12646accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12647defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12648reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12649After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
c906108c
SS
12650@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
12651
12652You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12653documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12654does not change the documentation.
12655
12656@kindex help user-defined
12657@item help user-defined
12658List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12659(if any) for each.
12660
12661@kindex show user
12662@item show user
12663@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
12664Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12665not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 12666definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 12667
c906108c
SS
12668@end table
12669
12670When user-defined commands are executed, the
12671commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12672stops execution of the user-defined command.
12673
12674If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
5d161b24
DB
12675without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12676commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
c906108c
SS
12677messages when used in a user-defined command.
12678
6d2ebf8b 12679@node Hooks
c906108c 12680@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
12681@cindex command hooks
12682@cindex hooks, for commands
c78b4128 12683@cindex hooks, pre-command
c906108c 12684
c78b4128
EZ
12685@kindex hook
12686@kindex hook-
12687You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
c906108c
SS
12688command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12689command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12690before that command.
12691
c78b4128
EZ
12692@cindex hooks, post-command
12693@kindex hookpost
12694@kindex hookpost-
12695A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12696Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12697@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12698that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12699pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12700
12701It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12702occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12703
12704@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12705@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12706
d4f3574e 12707@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
12708In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12709(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12710execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12711displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12712
c906108c
SS
12713For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12714single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12715you could define:
12716
12717@example
12718define hook-stop
12719handle SIGALRM nopass
12720end
12721
12722define hook-run
12723handle SIGALRM pass
12724end
12725
12726define hook-continue
12727handle SIGLARM pass
12728end
12729@end example
c906108c 12730
c78b4128
EZ
12731As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12732command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12733you could define:
12734
12735@example
12736define hook-echo
12737echo <<<---
12738end
12739
12740define hookpost-echo
12741echo --->>>\n
12742end
12743
12744(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12745<<<---Hello World--->>>
12746(@value{GDBP})
12747
12748@end example
12749
c906108c
SS
12750You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12751not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12752name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12753@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12754@c or not?
12755If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12756@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12757(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12758
12759If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12760get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12761
6d2ebf8b 12762@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
12763@section Command files
12764
12765@cindex command files
5d161b24
DB
12766A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12767commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12768An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
c906108c
SS
12769the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12770
12771@cindex init file
12772@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 12773@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c 12774When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
bf0184be
ND
12775@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
12776@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
12777following:
12778
12779@enumerate
12780@item
12781Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12782DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12783@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12784
12785@item
12786Processes command line options and operands.
12787
12788@item
12789Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12790
12791@item
12792Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12793@end enumerate
12794
12795The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12796complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12797and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12798option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12799
c906108c
SS
12800@cindex init file name
12801On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12802different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12803form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12804different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12805environments with special init file names:
12806
00e4a2e4 12807@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c
SS
12808@itemize @bullet
12809@item
00e4a2e4 12810VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12811
00e4a2e4 12812@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12813@item
00e4a2e4 12814OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12815
00e4a2e4 12816@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12817@item
00e4a2e4 12818ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12819@end itemize
c906108c
SS
12820
12821You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12822@code{source} command:
12823
12824@table @code
12825@kindex source
12826@item source @var{filename}
12827Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12828@end table
12829
12830The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12831printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12832of the command file.
12833
12834Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12835without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12836normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12837when called from command files.
12838
6d2ebf8b 12839@node Output
c906108c
SS
12840@section Commands for controlled output
12841
12842During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12843@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12844explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12845describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12846want.
12847
12848@table @code
12849@kindex echo
12850@item echo @var{text}
12851@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12852@c because it is not in ANSI.
12853Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12854@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12855newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12856In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12857by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12858string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
5d161b24 12859trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
c906108c
SS
12860To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12861@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12862
12863A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12864the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
12865
12866@example
12867echo This is some text\n\
12868which is continued\n\
12869onto several lines.\n
12870@end example
12871
12872produces the same output as
12873
12874@example
12875echo This is some text\n
12876echo which is continued\n
12877echo onto several lines.\n
12878@end example
12879
12880@kindex output
12881@item output @var{expression}
12882Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12883newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
5d161b24 12884value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
c906108c
SS
12885on expressions.
12886
12887@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12888Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12889the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12890formats}, for more information.
12891
12892@kindex printf
12893@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12894Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12895@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12896either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12897@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12898subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
12899@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12900@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12901@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12902@c supported.
c906108c
SS
12903
12904@example
12905printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12906@end example
12907
12908For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12909
12910@smallexample
12911printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12912@end smallexample
12913
12914The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12915string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12916letter.
12917@end table
12918
6d2ebf8b 12919@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
12920@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12921
12922@cindex Emacs
12923@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12924A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12925edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12926@value{GDBN}.
12927
12928To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
12929executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
12930@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12931created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 12932@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
12933
12934Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12935things:
12936
12937@itemize @bullet
12938@item
12939All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12940@end itemize
12941
12942This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
12943and output done by the program you are debugging.
12944
12945This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
12946commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
12947in this way.
12948
12949All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
12950with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
12951way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
12952stop.
12953
12954@itemize @bullet
12955@item
12956@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
12957@end itemize
12958
12959Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
12960source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
12961left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
12962source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
12963and the source.
12964
12965Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
12966usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
12967
12968@quotation
12969@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
12970current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
12971the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
12972appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
12973environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
12974session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
12975back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
12976avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
12977your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
12978@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
12979
12980A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
12981switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
12982@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
12983@end quotation
12984
12985By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
12986you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
12987several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
12988Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
12989
12990@example
12991(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
12992@end example
12993
12994@noindent
d4f3574e 12995(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
12996in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
12997``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
12998
12999In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13000addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13001
13002@table @kbd
13003@item C-h m
13004Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13005
13006@item M-s
13007Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13008update the display window to show the current file and location.
13009
13010@item M-n
13011Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13012calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13013to show the current file and location.
13014
13015@item M-i
13016Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13017display window accordingly.
13018
13019@item M-x gdb-nexti
13020Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13021display window accordingly.
13022
13023@item C-c C-f
13024Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13025@code{finish} command.
13026
13027@item M-c
13028Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13029command.
13030
13031@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13032
13033@item M-u
13034Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13035(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13036like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13037
13038@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13039
13040@item M-d
13041Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13042@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13043
13044@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13045
13046@item C-x &
13047Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13048of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13049around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13050then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13051argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13052
13053You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13054@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13055otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13056inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13057wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13058list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13059formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13060is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13061@end table
13062
13063In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13064tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13065
13066If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13067it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13068request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13069the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13070frame.
13071
13072The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13073which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13074the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13075communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13076delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13077to correspond properly with the code.
13078
13079@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13080@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13081@ignore
13082@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13083@kindex Epoch
13084@kindex inspect
13085
5d161b24 13086Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
c906108c
SS
13087called the @code{epoch}
13088environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13089@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13090each value is printed in its own window.
13091@end ignore
c906108c 13092
d700128c 13093@include annotate.texi
7162c0ca 13094@include gdbmi.texinfo
d700128c 13095
6d2ebf8b 13096@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
13097@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13098@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13099@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
13100
13101Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
13102
13103Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13104may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13105the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13106reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
13107
13108In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13109information that enables us to fix the bug.
13110
13111@menu
13112* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13113* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
13114@end menu
13115
6d2ebf8b 13116@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
13117@section Have you found a bug?
13118@cindex bug criteria
13119
13120If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
13121
13122@itemize @bullet
13123@cindex fatal signal
13124@cindex debugger crash
13125@cindex crash of debugger
13126@item
13127If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13128@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13129
13130@cindex error on valid input
13131@item
13132If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13133bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13134somewhere in the connection to the target.)
13135
13136@cindex invalid input
13137@item
13138If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13139that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13140``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13141for traditional practice''.
13142
13143@item
13144If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13145for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
13146@end itemize
13147
6d2ebf8b 13148@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
13149@section How to report bugs
13150@cindex bug reports
13151@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13152
c906108c
SS
13153A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13154If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13155contact that organization first.
13156
13157You can find contact information for many support companies and
13158individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13159distribution.
13160@c should add a web page ref...
13161
13162In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
13163@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
13164
13165@example
d4f3574e 13166bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
13167@end example
13168
13169@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 13170@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
13171not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13172@samp{bug-gdb}.
13173
13174The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13175serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13176the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13177newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13178problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13179path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13180we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13181bug reports to the mailing list.
13182
13183As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
13184
13185@example
13186@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
13187Free Software Foundation Inc.
1318859 Temple Place - Suite 330
13189Boston, MA 02111-1307
13190USA
13191@end example
c906108c
SS
13192
13193The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13194@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13195fact or leave it out, state it!
13196
13197Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13198problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13199assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13200Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13201stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13202name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13203of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13204the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13205easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
13206
13207Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13208bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13209you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13210self-contained.
13211
13212Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13213bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13214@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13215bugs properly.
13216
13217To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
13218
13219@itemize @bullet
13220@item
13221The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13222with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13223version}.
13224
13225Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13226the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
13227
13228@item
13229The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13230version number.
13231
c906108c
SS
13232@item
13233What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13234``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
13235
13236@item
13237What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13238debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13239C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13240information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13241compilers.
13242
13243@item
13244The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13245observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13246you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13247Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
13248
13249If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13250and then we might not encounter the bug.
13251
13252@item
13253A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13254reproduce the bug.
13255
13256@item
13257A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13258incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
13259
13260Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13261will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13262not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13263a chance to make a mistake.
13264
13265Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13266say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13267copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13268the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13269crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13270ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13271us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13272to draw any conclusion from our observations.
13273
c906108c
SS
13274@item
13275If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13276diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13277it by context, not by line number.
13278
13279The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13280sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 13281
c906108c
SS
13282@end itemize
13283
13284Here are some things that are not necessary:
13285
13286@itemize @bullet
13287@item
13288A description of the envelope of the bug.
13289
13290Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13291which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13292changes will not affect it.
13293
13294This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13295will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13296with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13297We recommend that you save your time for something else.
13298
13299Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13300of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13301output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13302less time, and so on.
13303
13304However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13305report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
13306
13307@item
13308A patch for the bug.
13309
13310A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13311the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13312a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13313to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
13314
13315Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13316construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13317through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13318to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
13319
13320And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13321patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13322help us to understand.
13323
13324@item
13325A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
13326
13327Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13328things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13329@end itemize
13330
5d161b24 13331@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
c906108c
SS
13332@c and consists of the two following files:
13333@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13334@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13335@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13336@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13337@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13338@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13339
13340
6d2ebf8b 13341@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
13342@appendix Formatting Documentation
13343
13344@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13345@cindex reference card
13346The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13347for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13348subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13349@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13350release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13351you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
13352
13353The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13354can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
13355
13356@example
13357make refcard.dvi
13358@end example
13359
5d161b24
DB
13360The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13361mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
c906108c
SS
13362that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13363high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13364your @sc{dvi} output program.
13365
13366@cindex documentation
13367
13368All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13369distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13370a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13371on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13372formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13373and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
13374
13375@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13376version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13377file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13378subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13379necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13380but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13381Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13382@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
13383
13384If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13385Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13386@code{makeinfo}.
13387
13388If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13389@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13390version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
13391
13392@example
13393cd gdb
13394make gdb.info
13395@end example
13396
13397If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13398a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13399Texinfo definitions file.
13400
13401@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13402produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13403document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13404has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13405command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13406(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13407require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
13408
13409@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13410@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13411written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13412typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13413and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13414directory.
13415
13416If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13417typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13418subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13419@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
13420
13421@example
13422make gdb.dvi
13423@end example
13424
13425Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 13426
6d2ebf8b 13427@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
13428@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13429@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13430@cindex installation
13431
c906108c
SS
13432@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13433of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13434build the @code{gdb} program.
13435@iftex
13436@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13437@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13438look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13439installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13440@end iftex
13441
5d161b24
DB
13442The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13443@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
c906108c
SS
13444appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
13445
13446For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13447@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
13448
13449@table @code
13450@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13451script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
13452
13453@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13454the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
13455
13456@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13457source for the Binary File Descriptor library
13458
13459@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
13460@sc{gnu} include files
13461
13462@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
13463source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
13464
13465@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
13466source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
13467
13468@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
13469source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
13470
13471@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
13472source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
13473
13474@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
13475source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
13476@end table
13477
13478The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
13479from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
13480this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
13481
13482First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
13483if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
13484identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
13485argument.
13486
13487For example:
13488
13489@example
13490cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13491./configure @var{host}
13492make
13493@end example
13494
13495@noindent
13496where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
13497@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
13498(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
13499correct value by examining your system.)
13500
13501Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
13502@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
13503libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
13504binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
13505
13506@need 750
13507@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
13508system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
13509shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
13510
13511@example
13512sh configure @var{host}
13513@end example
13514
13515If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
13516directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
13517@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
13518creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
13519you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
13520
13521You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
13522subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
13523configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
13524
13525For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
13526the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
13527
13528@example
13529@group
13530cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13531../configure @var{host}
13532@end group
13533@end example
13534
13535You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
13536However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
13537the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
13538that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
13539let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
13540
13541@menu
13542* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13543* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
13544* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
13545@end menu
13546
6d2ebf8b 13547@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
13548@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13549
13550If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
13551you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
13552host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
13553allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
13554rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
13555handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
13556@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
13557program specified there.
13558
13559To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
13560with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
13561(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
13562itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
13563would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
13564the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
13565
5d161b24 13566For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
c906108c
SS
13567separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
13568
13569@example
13570@group
13571cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13572mkdir ../gdb-sun4
13573cd ../gdb-sun4
13574../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
13575make
13576@end group
13577@end example
13578
13579When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
13580directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
13581(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
13582the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
13583directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
13584@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
13585
13586One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
5d161b24
DB
13587directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
13588@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
13589programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
c906108c
SS
13590You specify a cross-debugging target by
13591giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
13592
13593When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
13594it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
13595called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
13596
13597The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
13598directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
13599directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
13600directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
13601will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
13602
13603When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
13604directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
13605if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
13606with each other.
13607
6d2ebf8b 13608@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
13609@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
13610
13611The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
13612script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
13613aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
13614of information in the following pattern:
13615
13616@example
13617@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
13618@end example
13619
13620For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
13621or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
13622option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
13623
13624The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
13625any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
13626aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
13627@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
13628script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
13629abbreviations---for example:
13630
13631@smallexample
13632% sh config.sub i386-linux
13633i386-pc-linux-gnu
13634% sh config.sub alpha-linux
13635alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
13636% sh config.sub hp9k700
13637hppa1.1-hp-hpux
13638% sh config.sub sun4
13639sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
13640% sh config.sub sun3
13641m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
13642% sh config.sub i986v
13643Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
13644@end smallexample
13645
13646@noindent
13647@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
13648directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
13649
6d2ebf8b 13650@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
13651@section @code{configure} options
13652
13653Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
13654are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
13655several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
13656Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
13657
13658@example
13659configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
13660 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13661 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13662 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
13663 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
13664 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
13665 @var{host}
13666@end example
13667
13668@noindent
13669You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
13670@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
13671@samp{--}.
13672
13673@table @code
13674@item --help
13675Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
13676
13677@item --prefix=@var{dir}
13678Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13679@file{@var{dir}}.
13680
13681@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13682Configure the source to install programs under directory
13683@file{@var{dir}}.
13684
13685@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13686@need 2000
13687@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13688@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13689@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13690Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13691@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
13692build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13693directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13694the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13695directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
13696the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13697@var{dirname}.
13698
13699@item --norecursion
13700Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13701propagate configuration to subdirectories.
13702
13703@item --target=@var{target}
13704Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13705@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13706programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
13707
13708There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
13709
13710@item @var{host} @dots{}
13711Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
13712
13713There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13714@end table
13715
13716There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13717needed for special purposes only.
5d161b24 13718
6d2ebf8b 13719@node Index
c906108c
SS
13720@unnumbered Index
13721
13722@printindex cp
13723
13724@tex
13725% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
13726% meantime:
13727\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
13728\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
13729\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
13730\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
13731\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
13732\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
13733\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
13734\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
13735\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
13736\page\colophon
13737% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
13738@end tex
13739
449f3b6c
AC
13740@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
13741@ifinfo
c906108c 13742@contents
449f3b6c
AC
13743@end ifinfo
13744@ifhtml
13745@contents
13746@end ifhtml
13747
c906108c 13748@bye
This page took 0.966479 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.